[PATCH] Report LTO phase in lto1 process name v2
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobaf5f80906950c45c8734e726a52896ea0bd53280
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
6 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
7 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
9 This file is part of GCC.
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
12 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
13 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
14 version.
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
17 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
18 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
19 for more details.
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
23 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
39 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
40 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
41 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
42 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
43 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
45 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
46 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
48 CIE = Common Information Entry
49 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
51 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
53 FDE = Frame Description Entry
54 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
55 how to restore registers
57 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
58 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
60 #include "config.h"
61 #include "system.h"
62 #include "coretypes.h"
63 #include "tm.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "version.h"
66 #include "flags.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "ggc.h"
82 #include "md5.h"
83 #include "tm_p.h"
84 #include "diagnostic.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "tree-pass.h"
94 #include "tree-flow.h"
96 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
97 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
99 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
100 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
102 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
103 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
104 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
105 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
106 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
107 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
108 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
109 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
110 #else
111 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
112 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
113 #endif
115 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
116 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
117 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
118 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
119 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
120 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #endif
123 #ifndef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
124 #define INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
125 #endif
127 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
128 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
129 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
130 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
131 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
132 #endif
134 /* Save the result of dwarf2out_do_frame across PCH. */
135 static GTY(()) bool saved_do_cfi_asm = 0;
137 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
138 translation unit. */
141 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
143 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
144 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
145 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
146 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
147 return true;
149 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
150 return true;
152 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
153 return true;
155 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
156 && targetm.except_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
157 return true;
159 return false;
162 /* Decide whether to emit frame unwind via assembler directives. */
165 dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm (void)
167 int enc;
169 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
170 return false;
171 #endif
172 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
173 return true;
174 if (!flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm || !dwarf2out_do_frame ())
175 return false;
176 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_PERSONALITY_DIRECTIVE)
177 return false;
179 /* Make sure the personality encoding is one the assembler can support.
180 In particular, aligned addresses can't be handled. */
181 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,/*global=*/1);
182 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
183 return false;
184 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,/*global=*/0);
185 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
186 return false;
188 /* If we can't get the assembler to emit only .debug_frame, and we don't need
189 dwarf2 unwind info for exceptions, then emit .debug_frame by hand. */
190 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
191 && !flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions
192 && targetm.except_unwind_info () != UI_DWARF2)
193 return false;
195 saved_do_cfi_asm = true;
196 return true;
199 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
200 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
201 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
202 #endif
204 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
205 must be kept around forever. */
206 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
208 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
209 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
210 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
211 it. */
212 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
214 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
215 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
216 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
217 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
218 define type declaration DIE's. */
219 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
221 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
222 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
223 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
224 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
225 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
226 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
227 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
228 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
229 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
230 static GTY(()) section *debug_dcall_section;
231 static GTY(()) section *debug_vcall_section;
232 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
233 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
234 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
236 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
237 personality CFI. */
238 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
240 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
241 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
242 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
243 #endif
245 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
246 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
247 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
249 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
250 Information instructions. The register number, offset
251 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
252 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
254 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
255 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
256 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
257 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
258 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
259 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
262 typedef union GTY(()) dw_cfi_oprnd_struct {
263 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
264 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
265 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
266 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
268 dw_cfi_oprnd;
270 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_cfi_struct {
271 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
272 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
273 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
274 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
275 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
276 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
278 dw_cfi_node;
280 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
281 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
282 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
283 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
284 of this structure. */
285 typedef struct GTY(()) cfa_loc {
286 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
287 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
288 unsigned int reg;
289 BOOL_BITFIELD indirect : 1; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
290 BOOL_BITFIELD in_use : 1; /* 1 if a saved cfa is stored here. */
291 } dw_cfa_location;
293 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
294 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
295 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
296 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
297 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
299 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_fde_struct {
300 tree decl;
301 const char *dw_fde_begin;
302 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
303 const char *dw_fde_end;
304 const char *dw_fde_vms_end_prologue;
305 const char *dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue;
306 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
307 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
308 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
309 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
310 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
311 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_switch_cfi; /* Last CFI before switching sections. */
312 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_realignment;
313 unsigned funcdef_number;
314 /* Dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
315 unsigned int drap_reg;
316 /* Virtual dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
317 unsigned int vdrap_reg;
318 /* These 3 flags are copied from rtl_data in function.h. */
319 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
320 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
321 unsigned nothrow : 1;
322 /* Whether we did stack realign in this call frame. */
323 unsigned stack_realign : 1;
324 /* Whether dynamic realign argument pointer register has been saved. */
325 unsigned drap_reg_saved: 1;
326 /* True iff dw_fde_begin label is in text_section or cold_text_section. */
327 unsigned in_std_section : 1;
328 /* True iff dw_fde_unlikely_section_label is in text_section or
329 cold_text_section. */
330 unsigned cold_in_std_section : 1;
331 /* True iff switched sections. */
332 unsigned dw_fde_switched_sections : 1;
333 /* True iff switching from cold to hot section. */
334 unsigned dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot : 1;
336 dw_fde_node;
338 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
339 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
341 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
342 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
343 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
344 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
345 pointers. */
346 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
347 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
348 #endif
350 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
351 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
352 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
353 as PTR_SIZE. */
355 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
356 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
357 #endif
359 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF 4 type signature. */
361 #ifndef DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE
362 #define DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE 8
363 #endif
365 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
366 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
367 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
368 bytes.
370 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
371 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
373 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
374 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
375 #endif
377 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
378 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
379 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
381 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
382 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
383 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
384 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
385 #else
386 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
387 #endif
388 #endif
390 /* CIE identifier. */
391 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
392 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
393 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
394 #else
395 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
396 #endif
398 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
399 information for each routine. */
400 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
402 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
403 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
405 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
406 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
408 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
409 fde_table. */
410 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
412 /* Get the current fde_table entry we should use. */
414 static inline dw_fde_ref
415 current_fde (void)
417 return fde_table_in_use ? &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1] : NULL;
420 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
421 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
423 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
424 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
425 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
426 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
427 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
429 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
430 const char *str;
431 unsigned int refcount;
432 enum dwarf_form form;
433 char *label;
436 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
438 /* True if the compilation unit has location entries that reference
439 debug strings. */
440 static GTY(()) bool debug_str_hash_forced = false;
442 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
443 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
445 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
446 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
448 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
450 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
451 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
453 /* The default cold text section. */
454 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
456 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
458 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
459 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
460 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
461 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
462 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
463 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *, dw_cfa_location *);
464 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
465 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
466 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
467 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
468 HOST_WIDE_INT);
469 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
470 static void output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref);
471 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
472 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
473 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
474 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
476 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
477 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
478 static void output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref);
479 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
480 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
481 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
482 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
483 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_aligned_loc
484 (HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT);
485 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
486 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *mem_loc_descriptor
487 (rtx, enum machine_mode mode, enum var_init_status);
489 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
490 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
491 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
492 #endif
494 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
495 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
496 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
498 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
499 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
500 #endif
502 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
503 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
504 #endif
506 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
507 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
508 #endif
510 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
511 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
512 #endif
514 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
515 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
516 #endif
518 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
519 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
520 #endif
521 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
522 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
523 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
524 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
525 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
526 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
527 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
528 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
529 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
530 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
532 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
533 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
534 registers. */
535 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
536 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
537 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
538 #else
539 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
540 #endif
541 #endif
543 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
544 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
545 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
546 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
547 #endif
549 /* Hook used by __throw. */
552 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
554 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
555 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
558 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
559 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
561 static inline char *
562 stripattributes (const char *s)
564 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
565 char *p = stripped;
567 *p++ = '*';
569 while (*s && *s != ',')
570 *p++ = *s++;
572 *p = '\0';
573 return stripped;
576 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
577 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
579 static void
580 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
582 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
583 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
584 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
587 /* Divide OFF by DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, asserting no remainder. */
589 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
590 div_data_align (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
592 HOST_WIDE_INT r = off / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
593 gcc_assert (r * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == off);
594 return r;
597 /* Return true if we need a signed version of a given opcode
598 (e.g. DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf vs DW_CFA_offset_extended). */
600 static inline bool
601 need_data_align_sf_opcode (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
603 return DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT < 0 ? off > 0 : off < 0;
606 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
608 void
609 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
611 unsigned int i;
612 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
613 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
614 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
615 bool wrote_return_column = false;
617 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
619 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
621 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
623 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
624 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
625 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
627 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
628 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
629 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
631 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
632 continue;
633 wrote_return_column = true;
635 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
636 if (offset < 0)
637 continue;
639 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
640 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
644 if (!wrote_return_column)
645 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
647 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
648 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
649 #endif
651 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
654 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
656 static const char *
657 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
659 switch (cfi_opc)
661 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
662 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
663 case DW_CFA_offset:
664 return "DW_CFA_offset";
665 case DW_CFA_restore:
666 return "DW_CFA_restore";
667 case DW_CFA_nop:
668 return "DW_CFA_nop";
669 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
670 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
671 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
672 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
673 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
674 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
675 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
676 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
677 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
678 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
679 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
680 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
681 case DW_CFA_undefined:
682 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
683 case DW_CFA_same_value:
684 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
685 case DW_CFA_register:
686 return "DW_CFA_register";
687 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
688 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
689 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
690 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
691 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
692 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
693 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
694 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
695 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
696 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
698 /* DWARF 3 */
699 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
700 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
701 case DW_CFA_expression:
702 return "DW_CFA_expression";
703 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
704 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
705 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
706 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
707 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
708 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
710 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
711 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
712 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
714 /* GNU extensions */
715 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
716 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
717 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
718 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
719 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
720 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
722 default:
723 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
727 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
729 static inline dw_cfi_ref
730 new_cfi (void)
732 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc_dw_cfi_node ();
734 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
735 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
736 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
738 return cfi;
741 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
743 static inline void
744 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
746 dw_cfi_ref *p;
747 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
749 /* When DRAP is used, CFA is defined with an expression. Redefine
750 CFA may lead to a different CFA value. */
751 /* ??? Of course, this heuristic fails when we're annotating epilogues,
752 because of course we'll always want to redefine the CFA back to the
753 stack pointer on the way out. Where should we move this check? */
754 if (0 && fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
755 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
757 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
758 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
759 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
760 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
761 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
762 gcc_unreachable ();
764 default:
765 break;
768 /* Find the end of the chain. */
769 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
772 *p = cfi;
775 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. FORCE is true
776 if a label needs to be output even when using .cfi_* directives. */
778 char *
779 dwarf2out_cfi_label (bool force)
781 static char label[20];
783 if (!force && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
785 /* In this case, we will be emitting the asm directive instead of
786 the label, so just return a placeholder to keep the rest of the
787 interfaces happy. */
788 strcpy (label, "<do not output>");
790 else
792 int num = dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++;
793 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", num);
794 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LCFI", num);
797 return label;
800 /* True if remember_state should be emitted before following CFI directive. */
801 static bool emit_cfa_remember;
803 /* True if any CFI directives were emitted at the current insn. */
804 static bool any_cfis_emitted;
806 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
807 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
809 static void
810 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
812 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
814 if (emit_cfa_remember)
816 dw_cfi_ref cfi_remember;
818 /* Emit the state save. */
819 emit_cfa_remember = false;
820 cfi_remember = new_cfi ();
821 cfi_remember->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_remember_state;
822 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi_remember);
825 list_head = &cie_cfi_head;
827 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
829 if (label)
831 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
833 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
835 /* We still have to add the cfi to the list so that lookup_cfa
836 works later on. When -g2 and above we even need to force
837 emitting of CFI labels and add to list a DW_CFA_set_loc for
838 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list purposes. If we're generating
839 DWARF3 output we use DW_OP_call_frame_cfa and so don't use
840 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
841 if (dwarf_version == 2
842 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
843 && (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
844 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG))
846 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
848 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
849 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
850 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
851 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
852 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
853 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
854 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
855 if (*label == 0 || strcmp (label, "<do not output>") == 0)
856 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (true);
858 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
859 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
861 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
863 label = xstrdup (label);
865 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
866 xcfi = new_cfi ();
867 /* It doesn't metter whether DW_CFA_set_loc
868 or DW_CFA_advance_loc4 is added here, those aren't
869 emitted into assembly, only looked up by
870 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
871 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_set_loc;
872 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
873 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
874 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
876 break;
877 default:
878 break;
882 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
884 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
885 any_cfis_emitted = true;
887 /* ??? If this is a CFI for the CIE, we don't emit. This
888 assumes that the standard CIE contents that the assembler
889 uses matches the standard CIE contents that the compiler
890 uses. This is probably a bad assumption. I'm not quite
891 sure how to address this for now. */
893 else if (label)
895 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
897 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
899 if (*label == 0)
900 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
902 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
903 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
905 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
907 label = xstrdup (label);
909 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
910 xcfi = new_cfi ();
911 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
912 set the location directly using set_loc. */
913 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
914 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
915 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
916 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
917 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
919 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
922 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
923 any_cfis_emitted = true;
926 add_cfi (list_head, cfi);
929 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
931 static void
932 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc, dw_cfa_location *remember)
934 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
936 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
937 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
938 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
939 break;
940 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
941 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
942 break;
943 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
944 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
945 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
946 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
947 break;
948 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
949 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
950 break;
952 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
953 gcc_assert (!remember->in_use);
954 *remember = *loc;
955 remember->in_use = 1;
956 break;
957 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
958 gcc_assert (remember->in_use);
959 *loc = *remember;
960 remember->in_use = 0;
961 break;
963 default:
964 break;
968 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
970 static void
971 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
973 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
974 dw_fde_ref fde;
975 dw_cfa_location remember;
977 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
978 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
979 remember = *loc;
981 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
982 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
984 fde = current_fde ();
985 if (fde)
986 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
987 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
990 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
991 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
993 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
994 from the CFA. */
995 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
997 /* The current save location around an epilogue. */
998 static dw_cfa_location cfa_remember;
1000 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
1001 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
1003 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
1004 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
1006 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
1007 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
1008 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
1010 void
1011 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1013 dw_cfa_location loc;
1014 loc.indirect = 0;
1015 loc.base_offset = 0;
1016 loc.reg = reg;
1017 loc.offset = offset;
1018 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
1021 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
1023 static bool
1024 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
1026 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
1027 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
1028 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
1029 && (loc1->indirect == 0
1030 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
1033 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
1034 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
1036 static void
1037 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
1039 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1040 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
1042 cfa = *loc_p;
1043 loc = *loc_p;
1045 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
1046 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
1048 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
1049 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
1051 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
1052 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
1053 return;
1055 cfi = new_cfi ();
1057 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect && !old_cfa.indirect)
1059 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
1060 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. The data
1061 factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf happens in output_cfi, or
1062 in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa_offset directive. */
1063 if (loc.offset < 0)
1064 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
1065 else
1066 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
1067 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1070 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
1071 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
1072 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
1073 && !loc.indirect
1074 && !old_cfa.indirect)
1076 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
1077 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
1078 offset has not changed. */
1079 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
1080 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1082 #endif
1084 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
1086 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
1087 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
1088 the specified offset. The data factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
1089 happens in output_cfi, or in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa
1090 directive. */
1091 if (loc.offset < 0)
1092 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
1093 else
1094 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
1095 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1096 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1098 else
1100 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
1101 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
1102 register-offset pair is available. */
1103 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
1105 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
1106 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
1107 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
1110 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1113 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
1114 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
1115 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
1116 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
1118 static void
1119 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1121 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1122 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
1124 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1126 /* When stack is aligned, store REG using DW_CFA_expression with
1127 FP. */
1128 if (fde
1129 && fde->stack_realign
1130 && sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1132 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1133 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1134 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc
1135 = build_cfa_aligned_loc (offset, fde->stack_realignment);
1137 else if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1139 if (need_data_align_sf_opcode (offset))
1140 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
1141 else if (reg & ~0x3f)
1142 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
1143 else
1144 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
1145 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
1147 else if (sreg == reg)
1148 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
1149 else
1151 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
1152 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
1155 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1158 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
1159 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
1160 from the previous frame's window save area.
1162 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
1163 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
1165 void
1166 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
1168 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1170 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
1171 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1174 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
1175 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1177 void
1178 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1180 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1183 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
1184 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1186 void
1187 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1189 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1192 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
1193 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
1195 void
1196 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
1198 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
1201 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
1202 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
1204 static void
1205 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
1207 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1208 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1210 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1212 case REG:
1213 /* RA is in a register. */
1214 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
1215 break;
1217 case MEM:
1218 /* RA is on the stack. */
1219 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
1220 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1222 case REG:
1223 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1224 offset = 0;
1225 break;
1227 case PLUS:
1228 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1229 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1230 break;
1232 case MINUS:
1233 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1234 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1235 break;
1237 default:
1238 gcc_unreachable ();
1241 break;
1243 case PLUS:
1244 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1245 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1246 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1247 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
1248 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1249 return;
1251 default:
1252 gcc_unreachable ();
1255 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1256 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1259 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1260 contains. */
1262 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1263 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1264 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_offset)
1266 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1267 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1268 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1269 enum rtx_code code;
1271 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1273 code = GET_CODE (src);
1275 /* Assume (set (reg sp) (reg whatever)) sets args_size
1276 level to 0. */
1277 if (code == REG && src != stack_pointer_rtx)
1279 offset = -cur_args_size;
1280 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1281 offset = -offset;
1282 #endif
1283 return offset - cur_offset;
1286 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1287 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1288 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
1289 return 0;
1291 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1292 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1293 if (code == PLUS)
1294 offset = -offset;
1295 return offset;
1298 if (MEM_P (src) && !MEM_P (dest))
1299 dest = src;
1300 if (MEM_P (dest))
1302 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1303 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1304 code = GET_CODE (src);
1306 switch (code)
1308 case PRE_MODIFY:
1309 case POST_MODIFY:
1310 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1312 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1313 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1314 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1315 && CONST_INT_P (val));
1316 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1317 break;
1319 return 0;
1321 case PRE_DEC:
1322 case POST_DEC:
1323 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1325 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1326 break;
1328 return 0;
1330 case PRE_INC:
1331 case POST_INC:
1332 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1334 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1335 break;
1337 return 0;
1339 default:
1340 return 0;
1343 else
1344 return 0;
1346 return offset;
1349 /* Precomputed args_size for CODE_LABELs and BARRIERs preceeding them,
1350 indexed by INSN_UID. */
1352 static HOST_WIDE_INT *barrier_args_size;
1354 /* Helper function for compute_barrier_args_size. Handle one insn. */
1356 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1357 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1358 VEC (rtx, heap) **next)
1360 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1361 int i;
1363 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1365 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1366 /* Nothing */;
1367 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1368 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), cur_args_size, 0);
1369 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1370 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1372 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1373 for them. */
1374 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1375 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1376 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1377 cur_args_size, offset);
1380 else
1382 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1384 if (expr)
1386 expr = XEXP (expr, 0);
1387 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL
1388 || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1389 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (expr, 0); i++)
1391 rtx elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, i);
1393 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
1394 offset += stack_adjust_offset (elem, cur_args_size, offset);
1399 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1400 offset = -offset;
1401 #endif
1403 cur_args_size += offset;
1404 if (cur_args_size < 0)
1405 cur_args_size = 0;
1407 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1409 rtx dest = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1411 if (dest)
1413 if (barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] < 0)
1415 barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] = cur_args_size;
1416 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, *next, dest);
1421 return cur_args_size;
1424 /* Walk the whole function and compute args_size on BARRIERs. */
1426 static void
1427 compute_barrier_args_size (void)
1429 int max_uid = get_max_uid (), i;
1430 rtx insn;
1431 VEC (rtx, heap) *worklist, *next, *tmp;
1433 barrier_args_size = XNEWVEC (HOST_WIDE_INT, max_uid);
1434 for (i = 0; i < max_uid; i++)
1435 barrier_args_size[i] = -1;
1437 worklist = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1438 next = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1439 insn = get_insns ();
1440 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = 0;
1441 VEC_quick_push (rtx, worklist, insn);
1442 for (;;)
1444 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, worklist))
1446 rtx prev, body, first_insn;
1447 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size;
1449 first_insn = insn = VEC_pop (rtx, worklist);
1450 cur_args_size = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1451 prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1452 if (prev && BARRIER_P (prev))
1453 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (prev)] = cur_args_size;
1455 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1457 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
1458 continue;
1459 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1460 break;
1462 if (LABEL_P (insn))
1464 if (insn == first_insn)
1465 continue;
1466 else if (barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] < 0)
1468 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = cur_args_size;
1469 continue;
1471 else
1473 /* The insns starting with this label have been
1474 already scanned or are in the worklist. */
1475 break;
1479 body = PATTERN (insn);
1480 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
1482 HOST_WIDE_INT dest_args_size = cur_args_size;
1483 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1484 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0))
1485 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
1486 dest_args_size
1487 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1488 dest_args_size, &next);
1489 else
1490 cur_args_size
1491 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1492 cur_args_size, &next);
1494 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0)))
1495 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1496 dest_args_size, &next);
1497 else
1498 cur_args_size
1499 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1500 cur_args_size, &next);
1502 else
1503 cur_args_size
1504 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (insn, cur_args_size, &next);
1508 if (VEC_empty (rtx, next))
1509 break;
1511 /* Swap WORKLIST with NEXT and truncate NEXT for next iteration. */
1512 tmp = next;
1513 next = worklist;
1514 worklist = tmp;
1515 VEC_truncate (rtx, next, 0);
1518 VEC_free (rtx, heap, worklist);
1519 VEC_free (rtx, heap, next);
1522 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
1523 pushed onto the stack. */
1525 static void
1526 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1528 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1530 if (size == old_args_size)
1531 return;
1533 old_args_size = size;
1535 cfi = new_cfi ();
1536 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
1537 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
1538 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1541 /* Record a stack adjustment of OFFSET bytes. */
1543 static void
1544 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, const char *label)
1546 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1547 cfa.offset += offset;
1549 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1550 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1552 if (ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1553 return;
1555 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1556 offset = -offset;
1557 #endif
1559 args_size += offset;
1560 if (args_size < 0)
1561 args_size = 0;
1563 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1564 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1565 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1568 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1569 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out
1570 how much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1572 static void
1573 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1575 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1576 const char *label;
1577 int i;
1579 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1580 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1581 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1582 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1583 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1584 return;
1586 /* If INSN is an instruction from target of an annulled branch, the
1587 effects are for the target only and so current argument size
1588 shouldn't change at all. */
1589 if (final_sequence
1590 && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))
1591 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (insn))
1592 return;
1594 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1595 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1596 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1598 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1600 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1601 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1602 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1603 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1604 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1605 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1606 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1607 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1609 return;
1612 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1614 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1615 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1616 return;
1618 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1620 /* Don't call compute_barrier_args_size () if the only
1621 BARRIER is at the end of function. */
1622 if (barrier_args_size == NULL && next_nonnote_insn (insn))
1623 compute_barrier_args_size ();
1624 if (barrier_args_size == NULL)
1625 offset = 0;
1626 else
1628 offset = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1629 if (offset < 0)
1630 offset = 0;
1633 offset -= args_size;
1634 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1635 offset = -offset;
1636 #endif
1638 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1639 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), args_size, 0);
1640 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1641 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1643 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1644 for them. */
1645 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1646 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1647 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1648 args_size, offset);
1650 else
1651 return;
1653 if (offset == 0)
1654 return;
1656 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
1657 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
1660 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1661 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1662 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1664 struct GTY(()) queued_reg_save {
1665 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1666 rtx reg;
1667 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1668 rtx saved_reg;
1671 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1673 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1674 struct GTY(()) reg_saved_in_data {
1675 rtx orig_reg;
1676 rtx saved_in_reg;
1679 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1680 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1681 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1682 more efficient data structure. */
1683 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1684 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1686 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1688 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1689 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1691 static void
1692 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1694 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1696 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1697 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1698 order. */
1699 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1700 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1701 break;
1703 if (q == NULL)
1705 q = ggc_alloc_queued_reg_save ();
1706 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1707 queued_reg_saves = q;
1710 q->reg = reg;
1711 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1712 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1714 last_reg_save_label = label;
1717 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1719 void
1720 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1722 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1724 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1726 size_t i;
1727 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1729 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1730 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1731 break;
1732 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1734 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1735 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1737 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1739 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1740 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1743 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1744 if (q->saved_reg)
1745 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1746 else
1747 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1748 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1751 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1752 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1755 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1756 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1757 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1758 have a new location for? */
1760 static bool
1761 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1763 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1765 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1767 size_t i;
1768 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1769 return true;
1770 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1771 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1772 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1773 return true;
1776 return false;
1779 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1781 void
1782 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1784 size_t i;
1785 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1787 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1788 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1789 break;
1790 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1792 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1793 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1795 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1796 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1798 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1799 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1800 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1803 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1805 static rtx
1806 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1808 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1809 size_t i;
1810 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1812 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1813 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1814 return q->reg;
1816 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1817 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1818 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1819 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1821 return NULL_RTX;
1825 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1826 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1827 value, not an offset. */
1828 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1830 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_DEF_CFA note. */
1832 static void
1833 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1835 memset (&cfa, 0, sizeof (cfa));
1837 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
1839 case PLUS:
1840 cfa.reg = REGNO (XEXP (pat, 0));
1841 cfa.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1842 break;
1844 case REG:
1845 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1846 break;
1848 case MEM:
1849 cfa.indirect = 1;
1850 pat = XEXP (pat, 0);
1851 if (GET_CODE (pat) == PLUS)
1853 cfa.base_offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1854 pat = XEXP (pat, 0);
1856 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1857 break;
1859 default:
1860 /* Recurse and define an expression. */
1861 gcc_unreachable ();
1864 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1867 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_ADJUST_CFA note. */
1869 static void
1870 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1872 rtx src, dest;
1874 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == SET);
1875 dest = XEXP (pat, 0);
1876 src = XEXP (pat, 1);
1878 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1880 case PLUS:
1881 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1882 cfa.offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1883 break;
1885 case REG:
1886 break;
1888 default:
1889 gcc_unreachable ();
1892 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1893 gcc_assert (cfa.indirect == 0);
1895 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1898 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_OFFSET note. */
1900 static void
1901 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (rtx set, const char *label)
1903 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1904 rtx src, addr, span;
1906 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1907 addr = XEXP (set, 0);
1908 gcc_assert (MEM_P (addr));
1909 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1911 /* As documented, only consider extremely simple addresses. */
1912 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
1914 case REG:
1915 gcc_assert (REGNO (addr) == cfa.reg);
1916 offset = -cfa.offset;
1917 break;
1918 case PLUS:
1919 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1920 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)) - cfa.offset;
1921 break;
1922 default:
1923 gcc_unreachable ();
1926 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1928 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1929 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1930 if (!span)
1931 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src)), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1932 else
1934 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC live.
1935 Queue register saves for each piece of the PARALLEL. */
1936 int par_index;
1937 int limit;
1938 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
1940 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
1942 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
1943 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1945 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
1947 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (elem)),
1948 INVALID_REGNUM, span_offset);
1949 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
1954 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_REGISTER note. */
1956 static void
1957 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (rtx set, const char *label)
1959 rtx src, dest;
1960 unsigned sregno, dregno;
1962 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1963 dest = XEXP (set, 0);
1965 if (src == pc_rtx)
1966 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
1967 else
1968 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
1970 dregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
1972 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1973 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1974 reg_save (label, sregno, dregno, 0);
1977 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_EXPRESSION note. */
1979 static void
1980 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_expression (rtx set, const char *label)
1982 rtx src, dest, span;
1983 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1985 dest = SET_DEST (set);
1986 src = SET_SRC (set);
1988 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1989 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dest));
1991 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1992 gcc_assert (!span);
1994 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1995 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
1996 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc
1997 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (dest, 0), GET_MODE (dest),
1998 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
2000 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, were the interface different,
2001 and, as above, we could manage flushing for epilogues. */
2002 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2005 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_RESTORE note. */
2007 static void
2008 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (rtx reg, const char *label)
2010 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2011 unsigned int regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
2013 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = (regno & ~0x3f ? DW_CFA_restore_extended : DW_CFA_restore);
2014 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = regno;
2016 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2019 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
2020 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
2021 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
2022 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
2024 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
2025 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
2026 users need not read the source code.
2028 The High-Level Picture
2030 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
2031 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
2032 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
2033 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
2034 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
2036 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
2037 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
2038 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
2039 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
2040 saves. This also seems to work.
2042 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
2043 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
2044 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
2045 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
2046 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
2047 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
2048 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
2049 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
2050 value as in the caller.
2052 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
2053 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
2054 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
2055 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
2057 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
2058 register,
2060 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
2062 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
2063 consists of a register and an offset.
2064 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
2065 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
2066 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
2067 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
2068 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
2069 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
2070 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
2072 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
2073 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
2074 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
2075 cfa_temp.offset.
2077 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
2078 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
2079 and cfa_temp.offset.
2081 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
2082 stack.
2084 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
2085 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
2086 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
2088 Rules 16-20: If AND operation happens on sp in prologue, we assume
2089 stack is realigned. We will use a group of DW_OP_XXX
2090 expressions to represent the location of the stored
2091 register instead of CFA+offset.
2093 The Rules
2095 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
2096 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
2098 Rule 1:
2099 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
2100 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2101 cfa.offset unchanged
2102 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2103 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2105 Rule 2:
2106 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
2107 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
2108 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
2109 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
2110 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
2111 if cfa_store.reg==sp
2113 Rule 3:
2114 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2115 effects: cfa.reg = fp
2116 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
2118 Rule 4:
2119 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2120 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2121 <reg1> != sp
2122 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2123 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2124 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2126 Rule 5:
2127 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
2128 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2129 <reg1> != sp
2130 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
2131 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
2133 Rule 6:
2134 (set <reg> <const_int>)
2135 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2136 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2138 Rule 7:
2139 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
2140 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2141 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
2143 Rule 8:
2144 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
2145 effects: none
2147 Rule 9:
2148 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
2149 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2150 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2152 Rule 10:
2153 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
2154 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
2155 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2156 cfa.reg = sp
2157 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2159 Rule 11:
2160 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
2161 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2162 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2163 cfa.reg = sp
2164 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2166 Rule 12:
2167 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
2169 <reg2>)
2170 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2171 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2173 Rule 13:
2174 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
2175 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2176 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2178 Rule 14:
2179 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
2180 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2181 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
2182 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
2184 Rule 15:
2185 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
2186 effects: target-dependent
2188 Rule 16:
2189 (set sp (and: sp <const_int>))
2190 constraints: cfa_store.reg == sp
2191 effects: current_fde.stack_realign = 1
2192 cfa_store.offset = 0
2193 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg if cfa.reg != sp and cfa.reg != fp
2195 Rule 17:
2196 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) (mem (plus (cfa.reg) (const_int))))
2197 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2199 Rule 18:
2200 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) fp)
2201 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2202 effects: cfa_store.offset = 0
2203 cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2205 Rule 19:
2206 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) cfa.reg)
2207 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2208 && cfa.offset == 0
2209 && cfa.indirect == 0
2210 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2211 effects: Use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression to define cfa
2212 cfa.reg == fde->drap_reg */
2214 static void
2215 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
2217 rtx src, dest, span;
2218 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
2219 dw_fde_ref fde;
2221 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
2222 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
2223 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
2224 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
2225 flag is set in them. */
2226 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2228 int par_index;
2229 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
2230 rtx elem;
2232 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
2233 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
2234 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
2235 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
2236 handle register saves before register assignments. */
2237 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
2238 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2240 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2241 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2242 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
2243 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2244 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2247 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2249 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2250 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2251 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2252 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2253 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2254 else if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2255 && par_index != 0
2256 && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
2258 /* Stack adjustment combining might combine some post-prologue
2259 stack adjustment into a prologue stack adjustment. */
2260 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = stack_adjust_offset (elem, args_size, 0);
2262 if (offset != 0)
2263 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
2266 return;
2269 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
2271 src = SET_SRC (expr);
2272 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
2274 if (REG_P (src))
2276 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
2277 if (rsi)
2278 src = rsi;
2281 fde = current_fde ();
2283 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
2285 case REG:
2286 switch (GET_CODE (src))
2288 /* Setting FP from SP. */
2289 case REG:
2290 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
2292 /* Rule 1 */
2293 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
2294 relative to the current CFA register.
2296 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
2297 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
2298 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
2299 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
2300 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2301 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2302 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2304 else
2306 /* Saving a register in a register. */
2307 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
2308 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
2309 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
2310 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
2312 /* After stack is aligned, we can only save SP in FP
2313 if drap register is used. In this case, we have
2314 to restore stack pointer with the CFA value and we
2315 don't generate this DWARF information. */
2316 if (fde
2317 && fde->stack_realign
2318 && REGNO (src) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2319 gcc_assert (REGNO (dest) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2320 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
2321 && cfa.reg != REGNO (src));
2322 else
2323 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
2325 break;
2327 case PLUS:
2328 case MINUS:
2329 case LO_SUM:
2330 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
2332 /* Rule 2 */
2333 /* Adjusting SP. */
2334 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
2336 case CONST_INT:
2337 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2338 break;
2339 case REG:
2340 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
2341 == cfa_temp.reg);
2342 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
2343 break;
2344 default:
2345 gcc_unreachable ();
2348 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2350 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
2351 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2352 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2354 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
2355 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
2357 else
2358 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
2360 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2361 offset = -offset;
2362 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2363 cfa.offset += offset;
2364 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2365 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2367 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2369 /* Rule 3 */
2370 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
2371 or adjusting the FP */
2372 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
2374 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2375 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2376 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2377 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2378 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2379 offset = -offset;
2380 cfa.offset += offset;
2381 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2383 else
2385 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
2387 /* Rule 4 */
2388 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2389 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2390 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2392 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
2393 into the FP later on. */
2394 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2395 cfa.offset += offset;
2396 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2397 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
2398 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2399 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2402 /* Rule 5 */
2403 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2404 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2405 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2407 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
2408 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
2409 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2410 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
2411 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
2414 /* Rule 9 */
2415 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
2416 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2418 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2419 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2421 else
2422 gcc_unreachable ();
2424 break;
2426 /* Rule 6 */
2427 case CONST_INT:
2428 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2429 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
2430 break;
2432 /* Rule 7 */
2433 case IOR:
2434 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2435 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2436 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2438 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
2439 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2440 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2441 break;
2443 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
2444 which will fill in all of the bits. */
2445 /* Rule 8 */
2446 case HIGH:
2447 break;
2449 /* Rule 15 */
2450 case UNSPEC:
2451 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
2452 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
2453 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
2454 return;
2456 /* Rule 16 */
2457 case AND:
2458 /* If this AND operation happens on stack pointer in prologue,
2459 we assume the stack is realigned and we extract the
2460 alignment. */
2461 if (fde && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2463 /* We interpret reg_save differently with stack_realign set.
2464 Thus we must flush whatever we have queued first. */
2465 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2467 gcc_assert (cfa_store.reg == REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)));
2468 fde->stack_realign = 1;
2469 fde->stack_realignment = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2470 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2472 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2473 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2474 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg;
2476 return;
2478 default:
2479 gcc_unreachable ();
2482 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2483 break;
2485 case MEM:
2487 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
2488 CFA register. */
2489 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
2491 /* Rule 10 */
2492 /* With a push. */
2493 case PRE_MODIFY:
2494 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
2495 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
2496 == CONST_INT);
2497 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
2499 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2500 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2502 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2503 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2504 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2506 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2507 break;
2509 /* Rule 11 */
2510 case PRE_INC:
2511 case PRE_DEC:
2512 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2513 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
2514 offset = -offset;
2516 gcc_assert ((REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0))
2517 == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2518 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2520 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2522 /* Rule 18: If stack is aligned, we will use FP as a
2523 reference to represent the address of the stored
2524 regiser. */
2525 if (fde
2526 && fde->stack_realign
2527 && src == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2529 gcc_assert (cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2530 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2533 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2534 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2536 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2537 break;
2539 /* Rule 12 */
2540 /* With an offset. */
2541 case PLUS:
2542 case MINUS:
2543 case LO_SUM:
2545 int regno;
2547 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1))
2548 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2549 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
2550 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
2551 offset = -offset;
2553 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
2555 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2556 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2557 else
2559 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2560 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
2563 break;
2565 /* Rule 13 */
2566 /* Without an offset. */
2567 case REG:
2569 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
2571 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2572 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2573 else
2575 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2576 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2579 break;
2581 /* Rule 14 */
2582 case POST_INC:
2583 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
2584 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2585 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2586 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2587 break;
2589 default:
2590 gcc_unreachable ();
2593 /* Rule 17 */
2594 /* If the source operand of this MEM operation is not a
2595 register, basically the source is return address. Here
2596 we only care how much stack grew and we don't save it. */
2597 if (!REG_P (src))
2598 break;
2600 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2601 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2602 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
2604 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
2606 if (cfa.offset == 0)
2608 /* Rule 19 */
2609 /* If stack is aligned, putting CFA reg into stack means
2610 we can no longer use reg + offset to represent CFA.
2611 Here we use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instead. The
2612 result of this expression equals to the original CFA
2613 value. */
2614 if (fde
2615 && fde->stack_realign
2616 && cfa.indirect == 0
2617 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2619 dw_cfa_location cfa_exp;
2621 gcc_assert (fde->drap_reg == cfa.reg);
2623 cfa_exp.indirect = 1;
2624 cfa_exp.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2625 cfa_exp.base_offset = offset;
2626 cfa_exp.offset = 0;
2628 fde->drap_reg_saved = 1;
2630 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa_exp);
2631 break;
2634 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
2635 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
2636 on the ARM. */
2637 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2638 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
2639 break;
2641 else
2643 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
2644 calculate the CFA. */
2645 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
2647 if (!REG_P (x))
2648 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2649 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
2651 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
2652 cfa.base_offset = offset;
2653 cfa.indirect = 1;
2654 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2655 break;
2659 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2661 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2663 if (!span)
2664 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
2665 else
2667 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
2668 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
2669 PARALLEL. */
2670 int par_index;
2671 int limit;
2672 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2674 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2676 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2677 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2679 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2681 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
2682 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2686 break;
2688 default:
2689 gcc_unreachable ();
2693 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
2694 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
2695 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
2697 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
2698 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
2700 void
2701 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
2703 const char *label;
2704 rtx note, n;
2705 bool handled_one = false;
2707 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
2709 size_t i;
2711 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
2712 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2714 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
2715 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
2716 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
2717 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
2719 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2720 cfa_store = cfa;
2721 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
2722 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
2724 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
2726 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
2727 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
2729 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
2731 if (barrier_args_size)
2733 XDELETEVEC (barrier_args_size);
2734 barrier_args_size = NULL;
2736 return;
2739 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2740 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2742 if (!RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
2744 /* ??? This should be done unconditionally since stack adjustments
2745 matter if the stack pointer is not the CFA register anymore but
2746 is still used to save registers. */
2747 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
2748 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
2749 return;
2752 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2753 any_cfis_emitted = false;
2755 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
2756 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
2758 case REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR:
2759 insn = XEXP (note, 0);
2760 goto found;
2762 case REG_CFA_DEF_CFA:
2763 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (XEXP (note, 0), label);
2764 handled_one = true;
2765 break;
2767 case REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA:
2768 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2769 if (n == NULL)
2771 n = PATTERN (insn);
2772 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2773 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2775 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (n, label);
2776 handled_one = true;
2777 break;
2779 case REG_CFA_OFFSET:
2780 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2781 if (n == NULL)
2782 n = single_set (insn);
2783 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (n, label);
2784 handled_one = true;
2785 break;
2787 case REG_CFA_REGISTER:
2788 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2789 if (n == NULL)
2791 n = PATTERN (insn);
2792 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2793 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2795 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (n, label);
2796 handled_one = true;
2797 break;
2799 case REG_CFA_EXPRESSION:
2800 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2801 if (n == NULL)
2802 n = single_set (insn);
2803 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_expression (n, label);
2804 handled_one = true;
2805 break;
2807 case REG_CFA_RESTORE:
2808 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2809 if (n == NULL)
2811 n = PATTERN (insn);
2812 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2813 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2814 n = XEXP (n, 0);
2816 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (n, label);
2817 handled_one = true;
2818 break;
2820 case REG_CFA_SET_VDRAP:
2821 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2822 if (REG_P (n))
2824 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
2825 if (fde)
2827 gcc_assert (fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM);
2828 if (REG_P (n))
2829 fde->vdrap_reg = REGNO (n);
2832 handled_one = true;
2833 break;
2835 default:
2836 break;
2838 if (handled_one)
2840 if (any_cfis_emitted)
2841 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2842 return;
2845 insn = PATTERN (insn);
2846 found:
2847 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
2849 /* Check again. A parallel can save and update the same register.
2850 We could probably check just once, here, but this is safer than
2851 removing the check above. */
2852 if (any_cfis_emitted || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2853 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2856 /* Determine if we need to save and restore CFI information around this
2857 epilogue. If SIBCALL is true, then this is a sibcall epilogue. If
2858 we do need to save/restore, then emit the save now, and insert a
2859 NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE at the appropriate place in the stream. */
2861 void
2862 dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue (rtx insn)
2864 bool saw_frp = false;
2865 rtx i;
2867 /* Scan forward to the return insn, noticing if there are possible
2868 frame related insns. */
2869 for (i = NEXT_INSN (insn); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
2871 if (!INSN_P (i))
2872 continue;
2874 /* Look for both regular and sibcalls to end the block. */
2875 if (returnjump_p (i))
2876 break;
2877 if (CALL_P (i) && SIBLING_CALL_P (i))
2878 break;
2880 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == SEQUENCE)
2882 int idx;
2883 rtx seq = PATTERN (i);
2885 if (returnjump_p (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2886 break;
2887 if (CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0))
2888 && SIBLING_CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2889 break;
2891 for (idx = 0; idx < XVECLEN (seq, 0); idx++)
2892 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, idx)))
2893 saw_frp = true;
2896 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (i))
2897 saw_frp = true;
2900 /* If the port doesn't emit epilogue unwind info, we don't need a
2901 save/restore pair. */
2902 if (!saw_frp)
2903 return;
2905 /* Otherwise, search forward to see if the return insn was the last
2906 basic block of the function. If so, we don't need save/restore. */
2907 gcc_assert (i != NULL);
2908 i = next_real_insn (i);
2909 if (i == NULL)
2910 return;
2912 /* Insert the restore before that next real insn in the stream, and before
2913 a potential NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG -- we do need these notes to be
2914 properly nested. This should be after any label or alignment. This
2915 will be pushed into the CFI stream by the function below. */
2916 while (1)
2918 rtx p = PREV_INSN (i);
2919 if (!NOTE_P (p))
2920 break;
2921 if (NOTE_KIND (p) == NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK)
2922 break;
2923 i = p;
2925 emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE, i);
2927 emit_cfa_remember = true;
2929 /* And emulate the state save. */
2930 gcc_assert (!cfa_remember.in_use);
2931 cfa_remember = cfa;
2932 cfa_remember.in_use = 1;
2935 /* A "subroutine" of dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue. Emit the restore
2936 required. */
2938 void
2939 dwarf2out_frame_debug_restore_state (void)
2941 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2942 const char *label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2944 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_restore_state;
2945 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2947 gcc_assert (cfa_remember.in_use);
2948 cfa = cfa_remember;
2949 cfa_remember.in_use = 0;
2952 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
2953 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
2954 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2956 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2957 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2959 switch (cfi)
2961 case DW_CFA_nop:
2962 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2963 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
2964 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
2965 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2967 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2968 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2969 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2970 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2971 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2972 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
2974 case DW_CFA_offset:
2975 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2976 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2977 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2978 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2979 case DW_CFA_restore:
2980 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2981 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2982 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2983 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2984 case DW_CFA_register:
2985 case DW_CFA_expression:
2986 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2988 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2989 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2990 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2991 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2993 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2994 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2996 default:
2997 gcc_unreachable ();
3001 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
3002 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
3003 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
3005 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
3006 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
3008 switch (cfi)
3010 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3011 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3012 case DW_CFA_offset:
3013 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3014 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3015 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
3017 case DW_CFA_register:
3018 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
3020 case DW_CFA_expression:
3021 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
3023 default:
3024 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
3028 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
3029 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
3030 for collect2 the first time around. */
3032 static void
3033 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
3035 tree label;
3037 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
3038 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
3040 int flags;
3042 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
3044 int fde_encoding;
3045 int per_encoding;
3046 int lsda_encoding;
3048 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
3049 /*global=*/0);
3050 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
3051 /*global=*/1);
3052 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
3053 /*global=*/0);
3054 flags = ((! flag_pic
3055 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3056 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3057 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3058 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3059 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3060 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
3061 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
3063 else
3064 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
3065 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
3067 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
3069 if (eh_frame_section)
3070 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
3071 else
3073 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
3074 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
3075 switch_to_section (data_section);
3077 if (!back)
3079 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
3080 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3081 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
3082 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3083 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3088 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
3089 FOR_EH. */
3091 static void
3092 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
3094 if (for_eh)
3095 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
3096 else
3098 if (!debug_frame_section)
3099 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
3100 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
3101 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
3105 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
3107 static void
3108 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
3110 unsigned long r;
3111 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
3113 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
3114 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
3115 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
3116 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
3117 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
3118 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
3119 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
3121 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3122 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3123 "DW_CFA_offset, column %#lx", r);
3124 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3125 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3127 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
3129 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3130 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3131 "DW_CFA_restore, column %#lx", r);
3133 else
3135 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
3136 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
3138 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3140 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3141 if (for_eh)
3142 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
3143 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
3144 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
3145 false, NULL);
3146 else
3147 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3148 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
3149 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3150 break;
3152 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3153 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3154 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3155 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3156 break;
3158 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3159 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3160 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3161 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3162 break;
3164 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3165 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3166 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3167 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3168 break;
3170 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3171 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3172 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3173 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3174 break;
3176 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3177 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3178 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3179 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3180 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3181 break;
3183 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3184 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3185 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3186 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3187 break;
3189 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3190 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3191 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3192 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3193 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3194 break;
3196 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3197 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3198 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3199 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3200 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3201 break;
3203 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3204 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3205 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3206 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3207 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3208 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3209 break;
3211 case DW_CFA_register:
3212 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3213 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3214 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3215 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3216 break;
3218 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3219 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3220 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3221 break;
3223 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3224 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3225 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3226 break;
3228 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3229 break;
3231 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3232 case DW_CFA_expression:
3233 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
3234 break;
3236 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3237 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
3238 gcc_unreachable ();
3240 default:
3241 break;
3246 /* Similar, but do it via assembler directives instead. */
3248 static void
3249 output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3251 unsigned long r, r2;
3253 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3255 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3256 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3257 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3258 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3259 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3260 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3261 /* Should only be created by add_fde_cfi in a code path not
3262 followed when emitting via directives. The assembler is
3263 going to take care of this for us. */
3264 gcc_unreachable ();
3266 case DW_CFA_offset:
3267 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3268 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3269 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3270 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_offset %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3271 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3272 break;
3274 case DW_CFA_restore:
3275 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3276 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3277 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore %lu\n", r);
3278 break;
3280 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3281 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3282 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_undefined %lu\n", r);
3283 break;
3285 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3286 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3287 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_same_value %lu\n", r);
3288 break;
3290 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3291 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3292 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3293 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3294 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3295 break;
3297 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3298 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3299 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_register %lu\n", r);
3300 break;
3302 case DW_CFA_register:
3303 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3304 r2 = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3305 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_register %lu, %lu\n", r, r2);
3306 break;
3308 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3309 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3310 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_offset "
3311 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3312 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3313 break;
3315 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3316 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_remember_state\n");
3317 break;
3318 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3319 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore_state\n");
3320 break;
3322 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3323 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", DW_CFA_GNU_args_size);
3324 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3325 if (flag_debug_asm)
3326 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s args_size "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
3327 ASM_COMMENT_START, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3328 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3329 break;
3331 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3332 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_window_save\n");
3333 break;
3335 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3336 case DW_CFA_expression:
3337 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", cfi->dw_cfi_opc);
3338 output_cfa_loc_raw (cfi);
3339 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3340 break;
3342 default:
3343 gcc_unreachable ();
3347 DEF_VEC_P (dw_cfi_ref);
3348 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, heap);
3350 /* Output CFIs to bring current FDE to the same state as after executing
3351 CFIs in CFI chain. DO_CFI_ASM is true if .cfi_* directives shall
3352 be emitted, false otherwise. If it is false, FDE and FOR_EH are the
3353 other arguments to pass to output_cfi. */
3355 static void
3356 output_cfis (dw_cfi_ref cfi, bool do_cfi_asm, dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3358 struct dw_cfi_struct cfi_buf;
3359 dw_cfi_ref cfi2;
3360 dw_cfi_ref cfi_args_size = NULL, cfi_cfa = NULL, cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3361 VEC (dw_cfi_ref, heap) *regs = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, heap, 32);
3362 unsigned int len, idx;
3364 for (;; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3365 switch (cfi ? cfi->dw_cfi_opc : DW_CFA_nop)
3367 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3368 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3369 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3370 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3371 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3372 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3373 /* All advances should be ignored. */
3374 break;
3375 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3377 dw_cfi_ref args_size = cfi_args_size;
3379 /* Skip everything between .cfi_remember_state and
3380 .cfi_restore_state. */
3381 for (cfi2 = cfi->dw_cfi_next; cfi2; cfi2 = cfi2->dw_cfi_next)
3382 if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore_state)
3383 break;
3384 else if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_GNU_args_size)
3385 args_size = cfi2;
3386 else
3387 gcc_assert (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_remember_state);
3389 if (cfi2 == NULL)
3390 goto flush_all;
3391 else
3393 cfi = cfi2;
3394 cfi_args_size = args_size;
3396 break;
3398 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3399 cfi_args_size = cfi;
3400 break;
3401 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3402 goto flush_all;
3403 case DW_CFA_offset:
3404 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3405 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3406 case DW_CFA_restore:
3407 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3408 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3409 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3410 case DW_CFA_register:
3411 case DW_CFA_val_offset:
3412 case DW_CFA_val_offset_sf:
3413 case DW_CFA_expression:
3414 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
3415 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3416 if (VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs) <= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num)
3417 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs,
3418 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num + 1);
3419 VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, cfi);
3420 break;
3421 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3422 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3423 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3424 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3425 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3426 break;
3427 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3428 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3429 break;
3430 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3431 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3432 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3433 break;
3434 case DW_CFA_nop:
3435 gcc_assert (cfi == NULL);
3436 flush_all:
3437 len = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs);
3438 for (idx = 0; idx < len; idx++)
3440 cfi2 = VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, idx, NULL);
3441 if (cfi2 != NULL
3442 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore
3443 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore_extended)
3445 if (do_cfi_asm)
3446 output_cfi_directive (cfi2);
3447 else
3448 output_cfi (cfi2, fde, for_eh);
3451 if (cfi_cfa && cfi_cfa_offset && cfi_cfa_offset != cfi_cfa)
3453 gcc_assert (cfi_cfa->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression);
3454 cfi_buf = *cfi_cfa;
3455 switch (cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc)
3457 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3458 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
3459 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3460 break;
3461 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3462 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
3463 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3464 break;
3465 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3466 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3467 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc;
3468 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd2;
3469 break;
3470 default:
3471 gcc_unreachable ();
3473 cfi_cfa = &cfi_buf;
3475 else if (cfi_cfa_offset)
3476 cfi_cfa = cfi_cfa_offset;
3477 if (cfi_cfa)
3479 if (do_cfi_asm)
3480 output_cfi_directive (cfi_cfa);
3481 else
3482 output_cfi (cfi_cfa, fde, for_eh);
3484 cfi_cfa = NULL;
3485 cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3486 if (cfi_args_size
3487 && cfi_args_size->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset)
3489 if (do_cfi_asm)
3490 output_cfi_directive (cfi_args_size);
3491 else
3492 output_cfi (cfi_args_size, fde, for_eh);
3494 cfi_args_size = NULL;
3495 if (cfi == NULL)
3497 VEC_free (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs);
3498 return;
3500 else if (do_cfi_asm)
3501 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
3502 else
3503 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3504 break;
3505 default:
3506 gcc_unreachable ();
3510 /* Output one FDE. */
3512 static void
3513 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
3514 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
3515 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
3517 const char *begin, *end;
3518 static unsigned int j;
3519 char l1[20], l2[20];
3520 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3522 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
3523 /* empty */ 0);
3524 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
3525 for_eh + j);
3526 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3527 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3528 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3529 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
3530 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3531 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3532 "FDE Length");
3533 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3535 if (for_eh)
3536 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
3537 else
3538 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
3539 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
3541 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3543 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3544 end = fde->dw_fde_end;
3546 else
3548 /* For the first section, prefer dw_fde_begin over
3549 dw_fde_{hot,cold}_section_label, as the latter
3550 might be separated from the real start of the
3551 function by alignment padding. */
3552 if (!second)
3553 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3554 else if (fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3555 begin = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label;
3556 else
3557 begin = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
3558 if (second ^ fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3559 end = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
3560 else
3561 end = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
3564 if (for_eh)
3566 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
3567 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3568 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
3569 "FDE initial location");
3570 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
3571 end, begin, "FDE address range");
3573 else
3575 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
3576 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
3579 if (augmentation[0])
3581 if (any_lsda_needed)
3583 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
3585 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3587 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3588 + 4 /* CIE offset */
3589 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
3590 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
3591 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3593 size += pad;
3594 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
3597 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
3599 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3601 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3602 fde->funcdef_number);
3603 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
3604 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
3605 false,
3606 "Language Specific Data Area");
3608 else
3610 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3611 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3612 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
3613 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
3616 else
3617 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
3620 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
3621 this FDE. */
3622 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
3623 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3624 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3625 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3626 else if (!second)
3628 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3629 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3631 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3632 if (cfi == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3633 break;
3636 else
3638 dw_cfi_ref cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
3640 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3642 cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next;
3643 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
3644 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, false, fde, for_eh);
3645 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = cfi_next;
3647 for (cfi = cfi_next; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3648 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3651 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
3652 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
3653 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
3654 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
3655 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
3657 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
3658 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
3659 switch *back* into the table section. */
3660 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
3661 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
3662 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
3663 #endif
3665 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
3666 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3667 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
3668 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3670 j += 2;
3673 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
3675 static bool
3676 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
3678 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
3679 return true;
3681 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
3682 return true;
3684 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3685 return true;
3687 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
3688 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
3689 return false;
3691 return true;
3694 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
3695 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
3696 location of saved registers. */
3698 static void
3699 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
3701 unsigned int i;
3702 dw_fde_ref fde;
3703 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3704 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
3705 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
3706 char augmentation[6];
3707 int augmentation_size;
3708 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3709 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3710 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3711 int return_reg;
3712 rtx personality = NULL;
3713 int dw_cie_version;
3715 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
3716 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
3717 return;
3719 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
3720 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3721 return;
3723 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
3724 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
3725 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
3726 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
3727 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
3728 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
3729 if (for_eh)
3731 bool any_eh_needed = false;
3733 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3734 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
3735 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
3736 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (&fde_table[i]))
3737 any_eh_needed = true;
3738 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
3739 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
3740 1, 1);
3742 if (!any_eh_needed)
3743 return;
3746 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
3747 if (flag_debug_asm)
3748 app_enable ();
3750 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
3751 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
3753 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
3754 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
3756 /* Output the CIE. */
3757 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
3758 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
3759 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3760 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
3761 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3762 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3763 "Length of Common Information Entry");
3764 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3766 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
3767 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
3768 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
3769 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
3770 "CIE Identifier Tag");
3772 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
3773 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
3774 due to overflowing the return register column. */
3775 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
3776 dw_cie_version = 1;
3777 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
3778 dw_cie_version = 3;
3779 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
3781 augmentation[0] = 0;
3782 augmentation_size = 0;
3784 personality = current_unit_personality;
3785 if (for_eh)
3787 char *p;
3789 /* Augmentation:
3790 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
3791 augmentation section.
3792 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
3793 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
3794 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
3795 FDE code pointers.
3796 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
3797 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
3799 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
3800 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3801 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3803 p = augmentation + 1;
3804 if (personality)
3806 *p++ = 'P';
3807 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
3808 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
3810 if (any_lsda_needed)
3812 *p++ = 'L';
3813 augmentation_size += 1;
3815 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3817 *p++ = 'R';
3818 augmentation_size += 1;
3820 if (p > augmentation + 1)
3822 augmentation[0] = 'z';
3823 *p = '\0';
3826 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
3827 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3829 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3830 + 4 /* CIE Id */
3831 + 1 /* CIE version */
3832 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
3833 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
3834 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
3835 + 1 /* RA column */
3836 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
3837 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
3838 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3840 augmentation_size += pad;
3842 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
3843 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
3844 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
3848 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
3849 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
3851 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
3852 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
3854 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
3855 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
3856 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
3858 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
3859 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3860 else
3861 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3863 if (augmentation[0])
3865 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
3866 if (personality)
3868 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
3869 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
3870 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
3871 personality,
3872 true, NULL);
3875 if (any_lsda_needed)
3876 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
3877 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
3879 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3880 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
3881 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
3884 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3885 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
3887 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
3888 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3889 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
3890 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3892 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
3893 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3895 unsigned int k;
3896 fde = &fde_table[i];
3898 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
3899 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
3900 continue;
3902 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections ? 2 : 1); k++)
3903 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
3904 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
3907 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
3908 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
3909 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3910 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
3911 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
3912 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
3913 #endif
3915 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
3916 if (flag_debug_asm)
3917 app_disable ();
3920 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
3922 static void
3923 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
3925 int enc;
3926 rtx ref;
3927 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
3929 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
3931 if (personality)
3933 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3934 ref = personality;
3936 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
3937 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
3938 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
3939 of the weirder relocation types. */
3940 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3941 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3943 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
3944 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3945 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3948 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
3950 char lab[20];
3952 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3953 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3954 current_function_funcdef_no);
3955 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
3956 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3958 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3959 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3961 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
3962 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3963 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3967 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
3968 the prologue. */
3970 void
3971 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3972 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3974 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3975 char * dup_label;
3976 dw_fde_ref fde;
3977 section *fnsec;
3978 bool do_frame;
3980 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
3982 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
3984 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
3985 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
3986 if (!do_frame
3987 && (!flag_exceptions
3988 || targetm.except_unwind_info () != UI_TARGET))
3989 return;
3991 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
3992 switch_to_section (fnsec);
3993 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3994 current_function_funcdef_no);
3995 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3996 current_function_funcdef_no);
3997 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
3998 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
4000 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
4001 if (!do_frame)
4002 return;
4004 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
4005 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
4007 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4008 fde_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_fde_node, fde_table, fde_table_allocated);
4009 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
4010 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
4013 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
4014 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
4016 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
4017 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
4018 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
4019 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
4020 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
4021 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
4022 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
4023 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
4024 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
4025 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 0;
4026 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = 0;
4027 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
4028 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = NULL;
4029 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = NULL;
4030 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
4031 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = NULL;
4032 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
4033 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
4034 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
4035 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
4036 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
4037 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
4038 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
4040 section *unlikelysec;
4041 if (first_function_block_is_cold)
4042 fde->in_std_section = 1;
4043 else
4044 fde->in_std_section
4045 = (fnsec == text_section
4046 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
4047 unlikelysec = unlikely_text_section ();
4048 fde->cold_in_std_section
4049 = (unlikelysec == text_section
4050 || (cold_text_section && unlikelysec == cold_text_section));
4052 else
4054 fde->in_std_section
4055 = (fnsec == text_section
4056 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
4057 fde->cold_in_std_section = 0;
4060 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
4062 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
4063 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
4064 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4065 if (file)
4066 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
4067 #endif
4069 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4070 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
4071 else
4073 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4074 if (!current_unit_personality)
4075 current_unit_personality = personality;
4077 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
4078 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
4079 function anymore. */
4080 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
4081 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
4082 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
4086 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
4087 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
4088 been generated. */
4090 void
4091 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4092 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4094 dw_fde_ref fde;
4095 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4097 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4098 function. */
4099 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4100 current_function_funcdef_no);
4101 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4102 current_function_funcdef_no);
4103 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4104 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
4107 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
4108 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
4109 been generated. */
4111 void
4112 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4113 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4115 dw_fde_ref fde;
4116 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4118 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4119 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
4120 return;
4122 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4123 function. */
4124 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4125 current_function_funcdef_no);
4126 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4127 current_function_funcdef_no);
4128 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
4131 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
4132 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
4133 been generated. */
4135 void
4136 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4137 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4139 dw_fde_ref fde;
4140 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4142 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
4144 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4145 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4147 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4148 function. */
4149 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
4150 current_function_funcdef_no);
4151 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
4152 fde = current_fde ();
4153 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
4154 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
4157 void
4158 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
4160 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
4161 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_fde_node (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
4162 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4163 fde_table_in_use = 0;
4165 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
4166 sake of lookup_cfa. */
4168 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
4169 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
4171 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2
4172 || targetm.except_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
4173 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
4176 void
4177 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
4179 /* Output call frame information. */
4180 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
4181 output_call_frame_info (0);
4183 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
4184 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
4185 && targetm.except_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
4186 output_call_frame_info (1);
4189 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
4191 static void
4192 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
4194 section *sec = current_function_section ();
4195 if (sec == text_section)
4196 text_section_used = true;
4197 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
4198 cold_text_section_used = true;
4201 void
4202 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
4204 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
4206 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && !fde->dw_fde_switched_sections);
4208 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 1;
4209 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = !in_cold_section_p;
4211 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
4212 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4213 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
4214 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4215 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
4217 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
4218 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
4219 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
4221 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
4222 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
4223 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
4225 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4226 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4228 /* Now do the real section switch. */
4229 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
4231 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4233 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
4234 /* As this is a different FDE, insert all current CFI instructions
4235 again. */
4236 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, true, fde, true);
4238 else
4240 dw_cfi_ref cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4242 cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4243 if (cfi)
4244 while (cfi->dw_cfi_next != NULL)
4245 cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next;
4246 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = cfi;
4250 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
4251 for emitting location expressions. */
4253 /* Data about a single source file. */
4254 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
4255 const char * filename;
4256 int emitted_number;
4259 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
4260 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
4261 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
4262 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
4263 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
4265 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
4267 tree variable;
4268 dw_die_ref die;
4269 } deferred_locations;
4271 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
4272 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
4274 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
4276 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
4277 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
4279 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
4280 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
4281 implementation are listed below. */
4283 enum dw_val_class
4285 dw_val_class_addr,
4286 dw_val_class_offset,
4287 dw_val_class_loc,
4288 dw_val_class_loc_list,
4289 dw_val_class_range_list,
4290 dw_val_class_const,
4291 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
4292 dw_val_class_const_double,
4293 dw_val_class_vec,
4294 dw_val_class_flag,
4295 dw_val_class_die_ref,
4296 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
4297 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
4298 dw_val_class_lineptr,
4299 dw_val_class_str,
4300 dw_val_class_macptr,
4301 dw_val_class_file,
4302 dw_val_class_data8,
4303 dw_val_class_decl_ref,
4304 dw_val_class_vms_delta
4307 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
4309 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_vec_struct {
4310 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
4311 unsigned length;
4312 unsigned elt_size;
4314 dw_vec_const;
4316 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
4317 represented internally. */
4319 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_val_struct {
4320 enum dw_val_class val_class;
4321 union dw_val_struct_union
4323 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
4324 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
4325 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
4326 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
4327 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
4328 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
4329 double_int GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_const_double"))) val_double;
4330 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
4331 struct dw_val_die_union
4333 dw_die_ref die;
4334 int external;
4335 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
4336 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
4337 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
4338 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
4339 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
4340 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
4341 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_data8"))) val_data8[8];
4342 tree GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_decl_ref"))) val_decl_ref;
4343 struct dw_val_vms_delta_union
4345 char * lbl1;
4346 char * lbl2;
4347 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vms_delta"))) val_vms_delta;
4349 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
4351 dw_val_node;
4353 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
4354 operations. */
4356 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_descr_struct {
4357 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
4358 ENUM_BITFIELD (dwarf_location_atom) dw_loc_opc : 8;
4359 /* Used to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol relocation
4360 from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
4361 unsigned int dtprel : 1;
4362 int dw_loc_addr;
4363 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
4364 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
4366 dw_loc_descr_node;
4368 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
4369 so you can track variables that are in different places over
4370 their entire life. */
4371 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
4372 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
4373 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
4374 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
4375 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
4376 Only on head of list */
4377 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
4378 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
4379 } dw_loc_list_node;
4381 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4383 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
4385 static const char *
4386 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
4388 switch (op)
4390 case DW_OP_addr:
4391 return "DW_OP_addr";
4392 case DW_OP_deref:
4393 return "DW_OP_deref";
4394 case DW_OP_const1u:
4395 return "DW_OP_const1u";
4396 case DW_OP_const1s:
4397 return "DW_OP_const1s";
4398 case DW_OP_const2u:
4399 return "DW_OP_const2u";
4400 case DW_OP_const2s:
4401 return "DW_OP_const2s";
4402 case DW_OP_const4u:
4403 return "DW_OP_const4u";
4404 case DW_OP_const4s:
4405 return "DW_OP_const4s";
4406 case DW_OP_const8u:
4407 return "DW_OP_const8u";
4408 case DW_OP_const8s:
4409 return "DW_OP_const8s";
4410 case DW_OP_constu:
4411 return "DW_OP_constu";
4412 case DW_OP_consts:
4413 return "DW_OP_consts";
4414 case DW_OP_dup:
4415 return "DW_OP_dup";
4416 case DW_OP_drop:
4417 return "DW_OP_drop";
4418 case DW_OP_over:
4419 return "DW_OP_over";
4420 case DW_OP_pick:
4421 return "DW_OP_pick";
4422 case DW_OP_swap:
4423 return "DW_OP_swap";
4424 case DW_OP_rot:
4425 return "DW_OP_rot";
4426 case DW_OP_xderef:
4427 return "DW_OP_xderef";
4428 case DW_OP_abs:
4429 return "DW_OP_abs";
4430 case DW_OP_and:
4431 return "DW_OP_and";
4432 case DW_OP_div:
4433 return "DW_OP_div";
4434 case DW_OP_minus:
4435 return "DW_OP_minus";
4436 case DW_OP_mod:
4437 return "DW_OP_mod";
4438 case DW_OP_mul:
4439 return "DW_OP_mul";
4440 case DW_OP_neg:
4441 return "DW_OP_neg";
4442 case DW_OP_not:
4443 return "DW_OP_not";
4444 case DW_OP_or:
4445 return "DW_OP_or";
4446 case DW_OP_plus:
4447 return "DW_OP_plus";
4448 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4449 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
4450 case DW_OP_shl:
4451 return "DW_OP_shl";
4452 case DW_OP_shr:
4453 return "DW_OP_shr";
4454 case DW_OP_shra:
4455 return "DW_OP_shra";
4456 case DW_OP_xor:
4457 return "DW_OP_xor";
4458 case DW_OP_bra:
4459 return "DW_OP_bra";
4460 case DW_OP_eq:
4461 return "DW_OP_eq";
4462 case DW_OP_ge:
4463 return "DW_OP_ge";
4464 case DW_OP_gt:
4465 return "DW_OP_gt";
4466 case DW_OP_le:
4467 return "DW_OP_le";
4468 case DW_OP_lt:
4469 return "DW_OP_lt";
4470 case DW_OP_ne:
4471 return "DW_OP_ne";
4472 case DW_OP_skip:
4473 return "DW_OP_skip";
4474 case DW_OP_lit0:
4475 return "DW_OP_lit0";
4476 case DW_OP_lit1:
4477 return "DW_OP_lit1";
4478 case DW_OP_lit2:
4479 return "DW_OP_lit2";
4480 case DW_OP_lit3:
4481 return "DW_OP_lit3";
4482 case DW_OP_lit4:
4483 return "DW_OP_lit4";
4484 case DW_OP_lit5:
4485 return "DW_OP_lit5";
4486 case DW_OP_lit6:
4487 return "DW_OP_lit6";
4488 case DW_OP_lit7:
4489 return "DW_OP_lit7";
4490 case DW_OP_lit8:
4491 return "DW_OP_lit8";
4492 case DW_OP_lit9:
4493 return "DW_OP_lit9";
4494 case DW_OP_lit10:
4495 return "DW_OP_lit10";
4496 case DW_OP_lit11:
4497 return "DW_OP_lit11";
4498 case DW_OP_lit12:
4499 return "DW_OP_lit12";
4500 case DW_OP_lit13:
4501 return "DW_OP_lit13";
4502 case DW_OP_lit14:
4503 return "DW_OP_lit14";
4504 case DW_OP_lit15:
4505 return "DW_OP_lit15";
4506 case DW_OP_lit16:
4507 return "DW_OP_lit16";
4508 case DW_OP_lit17:
4509 return "DW_OP_lit17";
4510 case DW_OP_lit18:
4511 return "DW_OP_lit18";
4512 case DW_OP_lit19:
4513 return "DW_OP_lit19";
4514 case DW_OP_lit20:
4515 return "DW_OP_lit20";
4516 case DW_OP_lit21:
4517 return "DW_OP_lit21";
4518 case DW_OP_lit22:
4519 return "DW_OP_lit22";
4520 case DW_OP_lit23:
4521 return "DW_OP_lit23";
4522 case DW_OP_lit24:
4523 return "DW_OP_lit24";
4524 case DW_OP_lit25:
4525 return "DW_OP_lit25";
4526 case DW_OP_lit26:
4527 return "DW_OP_lit26";
4528 case DW_OP_lit27:
4529 return "DW_OP_lit27";
4530 case DW_OP_lit28:
4531 return "DW_OP_lit28";
4532 case DW_OP_lit29:
4533 return "DW_OP_lit29";
4534 case DW_OP_lit30:
4535 return "DW_OP_lit30";
4536 case DW_OP_lit31:
4537 return "DW_OP_lit31";
4538 case DW_OP_reg0:
4539 return "DW_OP_reg0";
4540 case DW_OP_reg1:
4541 return "DW_OP_reg1";
4542 case DW_OP_reg2:
4543 return "DW_OP_reg2";
4544 case DW_OP_reg3:
4545 return "DW_OP_reg3";
4546 case DW_OP_reg4:
4547 return "DW_OP_reg4";
4548 case DW_OP_reg5:
4549 return "DW_OP_reg5";
4550 case DW_OP_reg6:
4551 return "DW_OP_reg6";
4552 case DW_OP_reg7:
4553 return "DW_OP_reg7";
4554 case DW_OP_reg8:
4555 return "DW_OP_reg8";
4556 case DW_OP_reg9:
4557 return "DW_OP_reg9";
4558 case DW_OP_reg10:
4559 return "DW_OP_reg10";
4560 case DW_OP_reg11:
4561 return "DW_OP_reg11";
4562 case DW_OP_reg12:
4563 return "DW_OP_reg12";
4564 case DW_OP_reg13:
4565 return "DW_OP_reg13";
4566 case DW_OP_reg14:
4567 return "DW_OP_reg14";
4568 case DW_OP_reg15:
4569 return "DW_OP_reg15";
4570 case DW_OP_reg16:
4571 return "DW_OP_reg16";
4572 case DW_OP_reg17:
4573 return "DW_OP_reg17";
4574 case DW_OP_reg18:
4575 return "DW_OP_reg18";
4576 case DW_OP_reg19:
4577 return "DW_OP_reg19";
4578 case DW_OP_reg20:
4579 return "DW_OP_reg20";
4580 case DW_OP_reg21:
4581 return "DW_OP_reg21";
4582 case DW_OP_reg22:
4583 return "DW_OP_reg22";
4584 case DW_OP_reg23:
4585 return "DW_OP_reg23";
4586 case DW_OP_reg24:
4587 return "DW_OP_reg24";
4588 case DW_OP_reg25:
4589 return "DW_OP_reg25";
4590 case DW_OP_reg26:
4591 return "DW_OP_reg26";
4592 case DW_OP_reg27:
4593 return "DW_OP_reg27";
4594 case DW_OP_reg28:
4595 return "DW_OP_reg28";
4596 case DW_OP_reg29:
4597 return "DW_OP_reg29";
4598 case DW_OP_reg30:
4599 return "DW_OP_reg30";
4600 case DW_OP_reg31:
4601 return "DW_OP_reg31";
4602 case DW_OP_breg0:
4603 return "DW_OP_breg0";
4604 case DW_OP_breg1:
4605 return "DW_OP_breg1";
4606 case DW_OP_breg2:
4607 return "DW_OP_breg2";
4608 case DW_OP_breg3:
4609 return "DW_OP_breg3";
4610 case DW_OP_breg4:
4611 return "DW_OP_breg4";
4612 case DW_OP_breg5:
4613 return "DW_OP_breg5";
4614 case DW_OP_breg6:
4615 return "DW_OP_breg6";
4616 case DW_OP_breg7:
4617 return "DW_OP_breg7";
4618 case DW_OP_breg8:
4619 return "DW_OP_breg8";
4620 case DW_OP_breg9:
4621 return "DW_OP_breg9";
4622 case DW_OP_breg10:
4623 return "DW_OP_breg10";
4624 case DW_OP_breg11:
4625 return "DW_OP_breg11";
4626 case DW_OP_breg12:
4627 return "DW_OP_breg12";
4628 case DW_OP_breg13:
4629 return "DW_OP_breg13";
4630 case DW_OP_breg14:
4631 return "DW_OP_breg14";
4632 case DW_OP_breg15:
4633 return "DW_OP_breg15";
4634 case DW_OP_breg16:
4635 return "DW_OP_breg16";
4636 case DW_OP_breg17:
4637 return "DW_OP_breg17";
4638 case DW_OP_breg18:
4639 return "DW_OP_breg18";
4640 case DW_OP_breg19:
4641 return "DW_OP_breg19";
4642 case DW_OP_breg20:
4643 return "DW_OP_breg20";
4644 case DW_OP_breg21:
4645 return "DW_OP_breg21";
4646 case DW_OP_breg22:
4647 return "DW_OP_breg22";
4648 case DW_OP_breg23:
4649 return "DW_OP_breg23";
4650 case DW_OP_breg24:
4651 return "DW_OP_breg24";
4652 case DW_OP_breg25:
4653 return "DW_OP_breg25";
4654 case DW_OP_breg26:
4655 return "DW_OP_breg26";
4656 case DW_OP_breg27:
4657 return "DW_OP_breg27";
4658 case DW_OP_breg28:
4659 return "DW_OP_breg28";
4660 case DW_OP_breg29:
4661 return "DW_OP_breg29";
4662 case DW_OP_breg30:
4663 return "DW_OP_breg30";
4664 case DW_OP_breg31:
4665 return "DW_OP_breg31";
4666 case DW_OP_regx:
4667 return "DW_OP_regx";
4668 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4669 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
4670 case DW_OP_bregx:
4671 return "DW_OP_bregx";
4672 case DW_OP_piece:
4673 return "DW_OP_piece";
4674 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4675 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
4676 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4677 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
4678 case DW_OP_nop:
4679 return "DW_OP_nop";
4681 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
4682 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
4683 case DW_OP_call2:
4684 return "DW_OP_call2";
4685 case DW_OP_call4:
4686 return "DW_OP_call4";
4687 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4688 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
4689 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4690 return "DW_OP_implicit_value";
4691 case DW_OP_stack_value:
4692 return "DW_OP_stack_value";
4693 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
4694 return "DW_OP_form_tls_address";
4695 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
4696 return "DW_OP_call_frame_cfa";
4697 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4698 return "DW_OP_bit_piece";
4700 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
4701 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
4702 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
4703 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
4704 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
4705 return "DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr";
4706 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
4707 return "DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer";
4709 default:
4710 return "OP_<unknown>";
4714 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
4715 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
4716 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
4718 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4719 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
4720 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
4722 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_descr_node ();
4724 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
4725 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4726 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
4727 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4728 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
4730 return descr;
4733 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
4734 REG and OFFSET. */
4736 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4737 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4739 if (reg <= 31)
4740 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
4741 offset, 0);
4742 else
4743 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
4746 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
4748 static inline void
4749 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4751 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
4753 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4754 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
4757 *d = descr;
4760 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
4762 static void
4763 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4765 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4766 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
4768 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
4770 if (!offset)
4771 return;
4773 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4774 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
4777 p = NULL;
4778 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
4779 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
4780 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
4781 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
4782 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
4784 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
4785 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
4786 if (p != NULL
4787 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
4788 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
4789 *p += offset;
4791 else if (offset > 0)
4792 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
4794 else
4796 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
4797 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
4801 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
4803 static void
4804 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4806 dw_loc_list_ref d;
4807 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
4808 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
4811 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
4812 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
4814 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
4816 static unsigned long
4817 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4819 unsigned long size = 1;
4821 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4823 case DW_OP_addr:
4824 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4825 break;
4826 case DW_OP_const1u:
4827 case DW_OP_const1s:
4828 size += 1;
4829 break;
4830 case DW_OP_const2u:
4831 case DW_OP_const2s:
4832 size += 2;
4833 break;
4834 case DW_OP_const4u:
4835 case DW_OP_const4s:
4836 size += 4;
4837 break;
4838 case DW_OP_const8u:
4839 case DW_OP_const8s:
4840 size += 8;
4841 break;
4842 case DW_OP_constu:
4843 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4844 break;
4845 case DW_OP_consts:
4846 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4847 break;
4848 case DW_OP_pick:
4849 size += 1;
4850 break;
4851 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4852 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4853 break;
4854 case DW_OP_skip:
4855 case DW_OP_bra:
4856 size += 2;
4857 break;
4858 case DW_OP_breg0:
4859 case DW_OP_breg1:
4860 case DW_OP_breg2:
4861 case DW_OP_breg3:
4862 case DW_OP_breg4:
4863 case DW_OP_breg5:
4864 case DW_OP_breg6:
4865 case DW_OP_breg7:
4866 case DW_OP_breg8:
4867 case DW_OP_breg9:
4868 case DW_OP_breg10:
4869 case DW_OP_breg11:
4870 case DW_OP_breg12:
4871 case DW_OP_breg13:
4872 case DW_OP_breg14:
4873 case DW_OP_breg15:
4874 case DW_OP_breg16:
4875 case DW_OP_breg17:
4876 case DW_OP_breg18:
4877 case DW_OP_breg19:
4878 case DW_OP_breg20:
4879 case DW_OP_breg21:
4880 case DW_OP_breg22:
4881 case DW_OP_breg23:
4882 case DW_OP_breg24:
4883 case DW_OP_breg25:
4884 case DW_OP_breg26:
4885 case DW_OP_breg27:
4886 case DW_OP_breg28:
4887 case DW_OP_breg29:
4888 case DW_OP_breg30:
4889 case DW_OP_breg31:
4890 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4891 break;
4892 case DW_OP_regx:
4893 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4894 break;
4895 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4896 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4897 break;
4898 case DW_OP_bregx:
4899 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4900 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
4901 break;
4902 case DW_OP_piece:
4903 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4904 break;
4905 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4906 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4907 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
4908 break;
4909 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4910 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4911 size += 1;
4912 break;
4913 case DW_OP_call2:
4914 size += 2;
4915 break;
4916 case DW_OP_call4:
4917 size += 4;
4918 break;
4919 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4920 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
4921 break;
4922 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4923 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
4924 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
4925 break;
4926 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
4927 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
4928 break;
4929 default:
4930 break;
4933 return size;
4936 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
4938 static unsigned long
4939 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4941 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
4942 unsigned long size;
4944 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
4945 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
4946 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4948 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
4949 break;
4950 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4952 if (! l)
4953 return size;
4955 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4957 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
4958 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4961 return size;
4964 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4965 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
4967 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
4969 static void
4970 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4972 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
4973 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
4975 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4977 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4978 case DW_OP_const2u:
4979 case DW_OP_const2s:
4980 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4981 break;
4982 case DW_OP_const4u:
4983 if (loc->dtprel)
4985 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
4986 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
4987 val1->v.val_addr);
4988 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
4989 break;
4991 /* FALLTHRU */
4992 case DW_OP_const4s:
4993 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4994 break;
4995 case DW_OP_const8u:
4996 if (loc->dtprel)
4998 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
4999 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
5000 val1->v.val_addr);
5001 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5002 break;
5004 /* FALLTHRU */
5005 case DW_OP_const8s:
5006 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5007 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5008 break;
5009 case DW_OP_skip:
5010 case DW_OP_bra:
5012 int offset;
5014 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5015 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5017 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
5019 break;
5020 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5021 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5022 switch (val2->val_class)
5024 case dw_val_class_const:
5025 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5026 break;
5027 case dw_val_class_vec:
5029 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
5030 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
5031 unsigned int i;
5032 unsigned char *p;
5034 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
5036 elt_size /= 2;
5037 len *= 2;
5039 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
5040 i < len;
5041 i++, p += elt_size)
5042 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
5043 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
5045 break;
5046 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5048 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
5050 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5052 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
5053 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
5055 else
5057 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
5058 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
5060 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5061 first, NULL);
5062 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5063 second, NULL);
5065 break;
5066 case dw_val_class_addr:
5067 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
5068 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
5069 break;
5070 default:
5071 gcc_unreachable ();
5073 break;
5074 #else
5075 case DW_OP_const2u:
5076 case DW_OP_const2s:
5077 case DW_OP_const4u:
5078 case DW_OP_const4s:
5079 case DW_OP_const8u:
5080 case DW_OP_const8s:
5081 case DW_OP_skip:
5082 case DW_OP_bra:
5083 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5084 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
5085 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
5086 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
5087 only doing unwinding. */
5088 gcc_unreachable ();
5089 #endif
5090 case DW_OP_const1u:
5091 case DW_OP_const1s:
5092 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5093 break;
5094 case DW_OP_constu:
5095 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5096 break;
5097 case DW_OP_consts:
5098 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5099 break;
5100 case DW_OP_pick:
5101 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5102 break;
5103 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5104 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5105 break;
5106 case DW_OP_breg0:
5107 case DW_OP_breg1:
5108 case DW_OP_breg2:
5109 case DW_OP_breg3:
5110 case DW_OP_breg4:
5111 case DW_OP_breg5:
5112 case DW_OP_breg6:
5113 case DW_OP_breg7:
5114 case DW_OP_breg8:
5115 case DW_OP_breg9:
5116 case DW_OP_breg10:
5117 case DW_OP_breg11:
5118 case DW_OP_breg12:
5119 case DW_OP_breg13:
5120 case DW_OP_breg14:
5121 case DW_OP_breg15:
5122 case DW_OP_breg16:
5123 case DW_OP_breg17:
5124 case DW_OP_breg18:
5125 case DW_OP_breg19:
5126 case DW_OP_breg20:
5127 case DW_OP_breg21:
5128 case DW_OP_breg22:
5129 case DW_OP_breg23:
5130 case DW_OP_breg24:
5131 case DW_OP_breg25:
5132 case DW_OP_breg26:
5133 case DW_OP_breg27:
5134 case DW_OP_breg28:
5135 case DW_OP_breg29:
5136 case DW_OP_breg30:
5137 case DW_OP_breg31:
5138 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5139 break;
5140 case DW_OP_regx:
5141 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5142 break;
5143 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5144 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5145 break;
5146 case DW_OP_bregx:
5147 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5148 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5149 break;
5150 case DW_OP_piece:
5151 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5152 break;
5153 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5154 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5155 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5156 break;
5157 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5158 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5159 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5160 break;
5162 case DW_OP_addr:
5163 if (loc->dtprel)
5165 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
5167 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
5168 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
5169 val1->v.val_addr);
5170 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5172 else
5173 gcc_unreachable ();
5175 else
5177 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5178 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
5179 #else
5180 gcc_unreachable ();
5181 #endif
5183 break;
5185 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
5187 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
5188 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
5189 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5190 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
5191 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
5192 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5194 break;
5196 default:
5197 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5198 break;
5202 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
5204 static void
5205 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5207 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5209 /* Output the opcode. */
5210 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
5211 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
5213 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
5214 output_loc_operands (loc);
5218 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5219 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
5221 static void
5222 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5224 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5225 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5227 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5229 case DW_OP_addr:
5230 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5231 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
5232 gcc_unreachable ();
5234 case DW_OP_const1u:
5235 case DW_OP_const1s:
5236 case DW_OP_pick:
5237 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5238 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5239 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5240 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
5241 break;
5243 case DW_OP_const2u:
5244 case DW_OP_const2s:
5245 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5246 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
5247 break;
5249 case DW_OP_const4u:
5250 case DW_OP_const4s:
5251 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5252 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
5253 break;
5255 case DW_OP_const8u:
5256 case DW_OP_const8s:
5257 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5258 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5259 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
5260 break;
5262 case DW_OP_skip:
5263 case DW_OP_bra:
5265 int offset;
5267 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5268 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5270 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5271 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
5273 break;
5275 case DW_OP_constu:
5276 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5277 case DW_OP_regx:
5278 case DW_OP_piece:
5279 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5280 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5281 break;
5283 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5284 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5285 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
5287 break;
5289 case DW_OP_consts:
5290 case DW_OP_breg0:
5291 case DW_OP_breg1:
5292 case DW_OP_breg2:
5293 case DW_OP_breg3:
5294 case DW_OP_breg4:
5295 case DW_OP_breg5:
5296 case DW_OP_breg6:
5297 case DW_OP_breg7:
5298 case DW_OP_breg8:
5299 case DW_OP_breg9:
5300 case DW_OP_breg10:
5301 case DW_OP_breg11:
5302 case DW_OP_breg12:
5303 case DW_OP_breg13:
5304 case DW_OP_breg14:
5305 case DW_OP_breg15:
5306 case DW_OP_breg16:
5307 case DW_OP_breg17:
5308 case DW_OP_breg18:
5309 case DW_OP_breg19:
5310 case DW_OP_breg20:
5311 case DW_OP_breg21:
5312 case DW_OP_breg22:
5313 case DW_OP_breg23:
5314 case DW_OP_breg24:
5315 case DW_OP_breg25:
5316 case DW_OP_breg26:
5317 case DW_OP_breg27:
5318 case DW_OP_breg28:
5319 case DW_OP_breg29:
5320 case DW_OP_breg30:
5321 case DW_OP_breg31:
5322 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5323 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5324 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
5325 break;
5327 case DW_OP_bregx:
5328 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5329 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5330 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5331 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
5332 break;
5334 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
5335 gcc_unreachable ();
5336 break;
5338 default:
5339 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5340 break;
5344 static void
5345 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5347 while (1)
5349 /* Output the opcode. */
5350 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", loc->dw_loc_opc);
5351 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
5353 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
5354 break;
5355 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5357 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5361 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
5362 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
5364 static void
5365 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5367 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5368 unsigned long size;
5370 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5372 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, NULL);
5373 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5375 else
5376 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5378 /* Output the size of the block. */
5379 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5380 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
5382 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5383 output_loc_sequence (loc);
5386 /* Similar, but used for .cfi_escape. */
5388 static void
5389 output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5391 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5392 unsigned long size;
5394 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5396 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x,", cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
5397 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5399 else
5400 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5402 /* Output the size of the block. */
5403 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5404 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (size);
5405 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5407 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5408 output_loc_sequence_raw (loc);
5411 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
5412 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
5413 expression. */
5415 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5416 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5418 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
5420 offset += cfa->offset;
5422 if (cfa->indirect)
5424 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
5425 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5426 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
5427 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5428 if (offset != 0)
5430 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
5431 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5434 else
5435 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
5437 return head;
5440 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
5441 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
5442 ALIGNMENT byte. */
5444 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5445 build_cfa_aligned_loc (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
5447 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
5448 unsigned int dwarf_fp
5449 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
5451 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
5452 if (cfa.reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa.indirect == 0)
5454 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
5455 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
5456 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
5457 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
5459 else
5460 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
5461 return head;
5464 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
5465 descriptor sequence. */
5467 static void
5468 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
5470 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
5471 cfa->offset = 0;
5472 cfa->base_offset = 0;
5473 cfa->indirect = 0;
5474 cfa->reg = -1;
5476 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
5478 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
5480 switch (op)
5482 case DW_OP_reg0:
5483 case DW_OP_reg1:
5484 case DW_OP_reg2:
5485 case DW_OP_reg3:
5486 case DW_OP_reg4:
5487 case DW_OP_reg5:
5488 case DW_OP_reg6:
5489 case DW_OP_reg7:
5490 case DW_OP_reg8:
5491 case DW_OP_reg9:
5492 case DW_OP_reg10:
5493 case DW_OP_reg11:
5494 case DW_OP_reg12:
5495 case DW_OP_reg13:
5496 case DW_OP_reg14:
5497 case DW_OP_reg15:
5498 case DW_OP_reg16:
5499 case DW_OP_reg17:
5500 case DW_OP_reg18:
5501 case DW_OP_reg19:
5502 case DW_OP_reg20:
5503 case DW_OP_reg21:
5504 case DW_OP_reg22:
5505 case DW_OP_reg23:
5506 case DW_OP_reg24:
5507 case DW_OP_reg25:
5508 case DW_OP_reg26:
5509 case DW_OP_reg27:
5510 case DW_OP_reg28:
5511 case DW_OP_reg29:
5512 case DW_OP_reg30:
5513 case DW_OP_reg31:
5514 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
5515 break;
5516 case DW_OP_regx:
5517 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5518 break;
5519 case DW_OP_breg0:
5520 case DW_OP_breg1:
5521 case DW_OP_breg2:
5522 case DW_OP_breg3:
5523 case DW_OP_breg4:
5524 case DW_OP_breg5:
5525 case DW_OP_breg6:
5526 case DW_OP_breg7:
5527 case DW_OP_breg8:
5528 case DW_OP_breg9:
5529 case DW_OP_breg10:
5530 case DW_OP_breg11:
5531 case DW_OP_breg12:
5532 case DW_OP_breg13:
5533 case DW_OP_breg14:
5534 case DW_OP_breg15:
5535 case DW_OP_breg16:
5536 case DW_OP_breg17:
5537 case DW_OP_breg18:
5538 case DW_OP_breg19:
5539 case DW_OP_breg20:
5540 case DW_OP_breg21:
5541 case DW_OP_breg22:
5542 case DW_OP_breg23:
5543 case DW_OP_breg24:
5544 case DW_OP_breg25:
5545 case DW_OP_breg26:
5546 case DW_OP_breg27:
5547 case DW_OP_breg28:
5548 case DW_OP_breg29:
5549 case DW_OP_breg30:
5550 case DW_OP_breg31:
5551 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
5552 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5553 break;
5554 case DW_OP_bregx:
5555 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5556 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
5557 break;
5558 case DW_OP_deref:
5559 cfa->indirect = 1;
5560 break;
5561 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5562 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5563 break;
5564 default:
5565 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
5566 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
5571 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
5573 /* .debug_str support. */
5574 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
5576 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
5577 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
5578 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
5579 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
5580 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
5581 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
5582 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
5583 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
5584 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5585 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5586 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
5587 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
5588 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
5589 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
5590 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
5591 dw_die_ref);
5592 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
5593 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
5594 static void dwarf2out_direct_call (tree);
5595 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree, int);
5596 static void dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx, rtx);
5597 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call (int);
5598 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
5599 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
5601 /* The debug hooks structure. */
5603 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
5605 dwarf2out_init,
5606 dwarf2out_finish,
5607 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
5608 dwarf2out_define,
5609 dwarf2out_undef,
5610 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
5611 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
5612 dwarf2out_begin_block,
5613 dwarf2out_end_block,
5614 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
5615 dwarf2out_source_line,
5616 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
5617 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5618 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
5619 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
5620 #else
5621 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5622 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5623 #endif
5624 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
5625 dwarf2out_begin_function,
5626 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
5627 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
5628 dwarf2out_global_decl,
5629 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
5630 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
5631 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
5632 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
5633 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
5634 something tries to reference them. */
5635 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
5636 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
5637 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
5638 dwarf2out_var_location,
5639 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
5640 dwarf2out_direct_call,
5641 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token,
5642 dwarf2out_copy_call_info,
5643 dwarf2out_virtual_call,
5644 dwarf2out_set_name,
5645 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
5648 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
5649 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
5650 throughout the remainder of this file. */
5652 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
5653 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
5654 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
5655 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
5657 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
5658 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
5660 typedef long int dw_offset;
5662 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
5664 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
5665 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
5666 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
5667 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
5668 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
5669 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
5670 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
5672 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
5673 line number associated with the label generated for that
5674 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
5675 the line number entry. */
5677 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
5678 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5679 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5681 dw_line_info_entry;
5683 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
5684 own sequence. */
5685 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_separate_line_info_struct {
5686 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5687 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5688 unsigned long function;
5690 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
5692 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
5693 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
5694 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
5696 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
5697 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
5698 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
5700 dw_attr_node;
5702 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
5703 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
5705 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
5706 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
5707 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
5709 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
5710 union die_symbol_or_type_node
5712 char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
5713 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
5715 GTY ((desc ("dwarf_version >= 4"))) die_id;
5716 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
5717 dw_die_ref die_parent;
5718 dw_die_ref die_child;
5719 dw_die_ref die_sib;
5720 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
5721 dw_offset die_offset;
5722 unsigned long die_abbrev;
5723 int die_mark;
5724 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
5725 int die_perennial_p;
5726 unsigned int decl_id;
5727 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
5729 die_node;
5731 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
5732 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
5733 c = die->die_child; \
5734 if (c) do { \
5735 c = c->die_sib; \
5736 expr; \
5737 } while (c != die->die_child); \
5738 } while (0)
5740 /* The pubname structure */
5742 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
5743 dw_die_ref die;
5744 const char *name;
5746 pubname_entry;
5748 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
5749 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
5751 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
5752 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
5753 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
5754 int num;
5757 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
5758 const char *begin;
5759 const char *end;
5762 /* The comdat type node structure. */
5763 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
5765 dw_die_ref root_die;
5766 dw_die_ref type_die;
5767 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
5768 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
5770 comdat_type_node;
5772 /* The limbo die list structure. */
5773 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
5774 dw_die_ref die;
5775 tree created_for;
5776 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
5778 limbo_die_node;
5780 typedef struct GTY(()) skeleton_chain_struct
5782 dw_die_ref old_die;
5783 dw_die_ref new_die;
5784 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
5786 skeleton_chain_node;
5788 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
5789 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
5790 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
5791 #endif
5793 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
5794 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
5796 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
5797 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
5798 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
5799 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
5800 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
5801 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
5803 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
5804 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
5805 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
5806 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
5807 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
5808 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
5809 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
5810 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
5811 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
5812 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
5814 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
5815 language, and compiler version. */
5817 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
5818 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5819 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
5821 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
5822 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5823 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
5824 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
5826 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
5827 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
5829 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
5830 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
5831 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5832 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5833 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
5835 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
5836 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
5837 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
5838 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5839 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5840 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
5842 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
5843 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
5844 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
5845 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
5846 #else
5847 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
5848 #endif
5849 #endif
5851 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
5852 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
5853 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
5855 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
5856 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
5858 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
5859 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
5861 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
5862 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
5863 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
5864 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
5865 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
5867 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
5868 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
5869 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
5870 #endif
5872 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
5873 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
5874 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
5876 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
5877 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
5879 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
5880 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
5882 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
5883 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
5885 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
5886 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
5887 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
5889 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
5890 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
5892 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
5893 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
5894 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
5896 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
5897 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
5898 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
5900 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
5901 dw_die_ref die;
5902 tree arg;
5903 } die_arg_entry;
5905 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
5906 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
5908 /* Node of the variable location list. */
5909 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
5910 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
5911 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
5912 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
5913 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
5914 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
5915 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
5916 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
5917 NULL as second operand. */
5918 rtx GTY (()) loc;
5919 const char * GTY (()) label;
5920 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
5923 /* Variable location list. */
5924 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
5925 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
5927 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
5928 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
5929 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
5930 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
5931 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
5932 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
5933 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
5935 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
5936 unsigned int decl_id;
5938 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
5941 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
5942 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
5944 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
5945 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
5946 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
5947 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
5948 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
5950 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
5951 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
5953 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
5954 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5956 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5957 abbrev_die_table. */
5958 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
5960 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5961 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
5962 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
5963 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
5965 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
5966 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
5968 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
5969 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
5971 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5972 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
5973 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
5974 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
5976 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
5977 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
5979 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
5980 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
5982 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5983 line_info_table. */
5984 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
5986 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5987 accessible names. */
5988 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
5990 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5991 accessible types. */
5992 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
5994 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
5995 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
5997 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
5998 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
6000 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
6001 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
6003 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
6004 arange_table. */
6005 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
6007 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
6008 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
6010 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
6011 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
6013 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
6014 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
6016 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
6017 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
6018 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
6020 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
6021 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
6023 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
6024 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
6026 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
6027 ranges_table. */
6028 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
6030 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
6031 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
6033 /* Unique label counter. */
6034 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
6036 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
6037 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
6039 /* The direct call table structure. */
6041 typedef struct GTY(()) dcall_struct {
6042 unsigned int poc_label_num;
6043 tree poc_decl;
6044 dw_die_ref targ_die;
6046 dcall_entry;
6048 DEF_VEC_O(dcall_entry);
6049 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dcall_entry, gc);
6051 /* The virtual call table structure. */
6053 typedef struct GTY(()) vcall_struct {
6054 unsigned int poc_label_num;
6055 unsigned int vtable_slot;
6057 vcall_entry;
6059 DEF_VEC_O(vcall_entry);
6060 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(vcall_entry, gc);
6062 /* Pointers to the direct and virtual call tables. */
6063 static GTY (()) VEC (dcall_entry, gc) * dcall_table = NULL;
6064 static GTY (()) VEC (vcall_entry, gc) * vcall_table = NULL;
6066 /* A hash table to map INSN_UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
6068 struct GTY (()) vcall_insn {
6069 int insn_uid;
6070 unsigned int vtable_slot;
6073 static GTY ((param_is (struct vcall_insn))) htab_t vcall_insn_table;
6075 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
6076 static int current_function_has_inlines;
6078 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
6079 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
6081 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
6082 static GTY(()) int label_num;
6084 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
6085 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
6087 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
6089 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
6090 within the current function. */
6091 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
6093 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
6095 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
6096 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
6097 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
6098 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
6099 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
6100 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
6101 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
6102 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
6103 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
6104 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
6105 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6106 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
6107 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
6108 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
6109 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6110 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
6111 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6112 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6113 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
6114 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
6115 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
6116 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
6117 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
6118 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6119 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
6120 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
6121 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
6122 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6123 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
6124 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
6125 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
6126 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6127 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
6128 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
6129 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6130 dw_loc_list_ref);
6131 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
6132 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
6133 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
6134 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6135 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6136 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6137 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6138 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6139 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6140 unsigned long);
6141 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
6142 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6143 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
6144 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
6145 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6146 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6147 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6148 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6149 static bool is_cxx (void);
6150 static bool is_fortran (void);
6151 static bool is_ada (void);
6152 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6153 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
6154 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6155 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
6156 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
6157 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6158 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
6159 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6160 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
6161 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
6162 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6163 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
6164 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6165 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
6166 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6167 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
6168 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
6169 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
6170 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
6171 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6172 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
6173 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6174 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6175 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6176 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6177 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6178 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6179 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
6180 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6181 struct checksum_attributes;
6182 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
6183 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6184 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6185 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
6186 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
6187 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
6188 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
6189 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
6190 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6191 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
6192 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
6193 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
6194 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
6195 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
6196 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
6197 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
6198 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
6199 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
6200 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
6201 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
6202 static void copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6203 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
6204 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
6205 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
6206 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
6207 dw_die_ref);
6208 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
6209 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6210 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6211 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
6213 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
6214 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
6215 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
6216 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
6217 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
6218 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
6219 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
6220 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
6221 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6222 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
6223 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
6224 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6225 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6226 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
6227 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6228 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
6229 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6230 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6231 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
6232 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
6233 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
6234 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
6235 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
6236 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
6237 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
6238 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
6239 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
6240 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
6241 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6242 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
6243 static void output_aranges (void);
6244 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
6245 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
6246 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
6247 bool *);
6248 static void output_ranges (void);
6249 static void output_line_info (void);
6250 static void output_file_names (void);
6251 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
6252 static int is_base_type (tree);
6253 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6254 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6255 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6256 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6257 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
6258 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
6259 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
6260 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
6261 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
6262 enum var_init_status);
6263 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6264 enum var_init_status);
6265 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
6266 enum var_init_status);
6267 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
6268 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
6269 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6270 enum var_init_status);
6271 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6272 enum var_init_status);
6273 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
6274 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
6275 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
6276 static tree field_type (const_tree);
6277 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6278 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6279 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
6280 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
6281 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6282 dw_loc_list_ref);
6283 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6284 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
6285 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
6286 static void insert_double (double_int, unsigned char *);
6287 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
6288 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
6289 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
6290 enum dwarf_attribute);
6291 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6292 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
6293 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
6294 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
6295 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
6296 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
6297 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6298 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6299 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6300 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6301 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6302 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6303 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6304 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6305 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
6306 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
6307 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
6308 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6309 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6310 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6311 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6312 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6313 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
6314 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
6315 #if 0
6316 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
6317 #endif
6318 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6319 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
6320 #if 0
6321 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6322 #endif
6323 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6324 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6325 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
6326 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6327 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6328 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6329 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6330 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6331 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6332 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6333 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6334 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6335 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6336 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
6337 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6338 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6339 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
6340 enum debug_info_usage);
6341 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6342 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6343 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6344 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6345 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6346 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
6347 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
6348 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
6349 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6350 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6351 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
6352 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
6353 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
6354 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
6355 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
6356 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
6357 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6358 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
6359 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6360 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6361 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6362 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
6363 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
6364 const char *, const char *);
6365 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
6366 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
6368 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6369 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
6370 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
6371 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
6372 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
6373 static void prune_unused_types (void);
6374 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
6375 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref);
6376 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref);
6377 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6378 const char *, const char *);
6379 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
6380 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
6382 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
6383 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
6384 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
6385 #endif
6386 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
6387 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
6388 #endif
6389 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
6390 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
6391 #endif
6392 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
6393 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
6394 #endif
6395 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
6396 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
6397 #endif
6398 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
6399 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
6400 #endif
6401 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
6402 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
6403 #endif
6404 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
6405 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
6406 #endif
6407 #ifndef DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION
6408 #define DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION ".debug_dcall"
6409 #endif
6410 #ifndef DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION
6411 #define DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION ".debug_vcall"
6412 #endif
6413 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
6414 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
6415 #endif
6416 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
6417 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
6418 #endif
6420 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
6421 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6422 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
6423 #endif
6425 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
6426 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
6427 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
6428 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
6429 : SECTION_DEBUG)
6431 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
6432 the section names themselves. */
6434 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6435 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
6436 #endif
6437 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6438 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
6439 #endif
6440 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
6441 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
6442 #endif
6443 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
6444 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
6445 #endif
6446 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
6447 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
6448 #endif
6449 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
6450 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
6451 #endif
6452 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
6453 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
6454 #endif
6455 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
6456 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
6457 #endif
6460 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
6461 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
6462 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
6463 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
6464 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
6466 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6467 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6468 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6469 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6470 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6471 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6472 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6473 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6474 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6475 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6477 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
6478 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
6479 #endif
6480 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
6481 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
6482 #endif
6483 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
6484 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
6485 #endif
6486 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
6487 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
6488 #endif
6489 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
6490 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
6491 #endif
6492 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
6493 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
6494 #endif
6497 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
6498 static dw_die_ref
6499 comp_unit_die (void)
6501 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
6502 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
6503 return single_comp_unit_die;
6506 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
6507 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
6509 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
6511 void
6512 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
6514 demangle_name_func = func;
6517 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
6519 static inline int
6520 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
6522 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6523 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
6524 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
6527 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
6528 removed. */
6530 static inline tree
6531 type_main_variant (tree type)
6533 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6535 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
6536 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
6537 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
6538 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
6539 here. */
6540 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6541 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
6542 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6544 return type;
6547 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
6549 static inline int
6550 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
6552 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
6554 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
6555 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
6558 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
6560 static void
6561 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
6563 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
6566 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
6568 static const char *
6569 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
6571 switch (tag)
6573 case DW_TAG_padding:
6574 return "DW_TAG_padding";
6575 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6576 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
6577 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6578 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
6579 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
6580 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
6581 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6582 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
6583 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
6584 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
6585 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
6586 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
6587 case DW_TAG_label:
6588 return "DW_TAG_label";
6589 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
6590 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
6591 case DW_TAG_member:
6592 return "DW_TAG_member";
6593 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6594 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
6595 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6596 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
6597 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
6598 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
6599 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6600 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
6601 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6602 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
6603 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6604 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
6605 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6606 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
6607 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6608 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
6609 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
6610 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
6611 case DW_TAG_variant:
6612 return "DW_TAG_variant";
6613 case DW_TAG_common_block:
6614 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
6615 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
6616 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
6617 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
6618 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
6619 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
6620 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
6621 case DW_TAG_module:
6622 return "DW_TAG_module";
6623 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6624 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
6625 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6626 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
6627 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6628 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
6629 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
6630 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
6631 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
6632 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
6633 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6634 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
6635 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
6636 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
6637 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6638 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
6639 case DW_TAG_constant:
6640 return "DW_TAG_constant";
6641 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
6642 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
6643 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6644 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
6645 case DW_TAG_friend:
6646 return "DW_TAG_friend";
6647 case DW_TAG_namelist:
6648 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
6649 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
6650 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
6651 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6652 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
6653 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
6654 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
6655 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
6656 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
6657 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
6658 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
6659 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
6660 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
6661 case DW_TAG_try_block:
6662 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
6663 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
6664 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
6665 case DW_TAG_variable:
6666 return "DW_TAG_variable";
6667 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6668 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
6669 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
6670 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
6671 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
6672 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
6673 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6674 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
6675 case DW_TAG_namespace:
6676 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
6677 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
6678 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
6679 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
6680 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
6681 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
6682 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
6683 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
6684 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
6685 case DW_TAG_condition:
6686 return "DW_TAG_condition";
6687 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
6688 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
6689 case DW_TAG_type_unit:
6690 return "DW_TAG_type_unit";
6691 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6692 return "DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type";
6693 case DW_TAG_template_alias:
6694 return "DW_TAG_template_alias";
6695 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
6696 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack";
6697 case DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack:
6698 return "DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack";
6699 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
6700 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
6701 case DW_TAG_format_label:
6702 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
6703 case DW_TAG_function_template:
6704 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
6705 case DW_TAG_class_template:
6706 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
6707 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
6708 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
6709 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
6710 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
6711 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
6712 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param";
6713 default:
6714 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
6718 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
6720 static const char *
6721 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
6723 switch (attr)
6725 case DW_AT_sibling:
6726 return "DW_AT_sibling";
6727 case DW_AT_location:
6728 return "DW_AT_location";
6729 case DW_AT_name:
6730 return "DW_AT_name";
6731 case DW_AT_ordering:
6732 return "DW_AT_ordering";
6733 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
6734 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
6735 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6736 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
6737 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6738 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
6739 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6740 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
6741 case DW_AT_element_list:
6742 return "DW_AT_element_list";
6743 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
6744 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
6745 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6746 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
6747 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6748 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
6749 case DW_AT_language:
6750 return "DW_AT_language";
6751 case DW_AT_member:
6752 return "DW_AT_member";
6753 case DW_AT_discr:
6754 return "DW_AT_discr";
6755 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6756 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
6757 case DW_AT_visibility:
6758 return "DW_AT_visibility";
6759 case DW_AT_import:
6760 return "DW_AT_import";
6761 case DW_AT_string_length:
6762 return "DW_AT_string_length";
6763 case DW_AT_common_reference:
6764 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
6765 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
6766 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
6767 case DW_AT_const_value:
6768 return "DW_AT_const_value";
6769 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6770 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
6771 case DW_AT_default_value:
6772 return "DW_AT_default_value";
6773 case DW_AT_inline:
6774 return "DW_AT_inline";
6775 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6776 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
6777 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6778 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
6779 case DW_AT_producer:
6780 return "DW_AT_producer";
6781 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6782 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
6783 case DW_AT_return_addr:
6784 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
6785 case DW_AT_start_scope:
6786 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
6787 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6788 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
6789 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6790 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
6791 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
6792 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
6793 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6794 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
6795 case DW_AT_address_class:
6796 return "DW_AT_address_class";
6797 case DW_AT_artificial:
6798 return "DW_AT_artificial";
6799 case DW_AT_base_types:
6800 return "DW_AT_base_types";
6801 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
6802 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
6803 case DW_AT_count:
6804 return "DW_AT_count";
6805 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6806 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
6807 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6808 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
6809 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6810 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
6811 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6812 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
6813 case DW_AT_declaration:
6814 return "DW_AT_declaration";
6815 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6816 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
6817 case DW_AT_encoding:
6818 return "DW_AT_encoding";
6819 case DW_AT_external:
6820 return "DW_AT_external";
6821 case DW_AT_explicit:
6822 return "DW_AT_explicit";
6823 case DW_AT_frame_base:
6824 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
6825 case DW_AT_friend:
6826 return "DW_AT_friend";
6827 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
6828 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
6829 case DW_AT_macro_info:
6830 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
6831 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
6832 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
6833 case DW_AT_priority:
6834 return "DW_AT_priority";
6835 case DW_AT_segment:
6836 return "DW_AT_segment";
6837 case DW_AT_specification:
6838 return "DW_AT_specification";
6839 case DW_AT_static_link:
6840 return "DW_AT_static_link";
6841 case DW_AT_type:
6842 return "DW_AT_type";
6843 case DW_AT_use_location:
6844 return "DW_AT_use_location";
6845 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6846 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
6847 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6848 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
6849 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6850 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
6852 case DW_AT_allocated:
6853 return "DW_AT_allocated";
6854 case DW_AT_associated:
6855 return "DW_AT_associated";
6856 case DW_AT_data_location:
6857 return "DW_AT_data_location";
6858 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6859 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
6860 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
6861 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
6862 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6863 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
6864 case DW_AT_extension:
6865 return "DW_AT_extension";
6866 case DW_AT_ranges:
6867 return "DW_AT_ranges";
6868 case DW_AT_trampoline:
6869 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
6870 case DW_AT_call_column:
6871 return "DW_AT_call_column";
6872 case DW_AT_call_file:
6873 return "DW_AT_call_file";
6874 case DW_AT_call_line:
6875 return "DW_AT_call_line";
6876 case DW_AT_object_pointer:
6877 return "DW_AT_object_pointer";
6879 case DW_AT_signature:
6880 return "DW_AT_signature";
6881 case DW_AT_main_subprogram:
6882 return "DW_AT_main_subprogram";
6883 case DW_AT_data_bit_offset:
6884 return "DW_AT_data_bit_offset";
6885 case DW_AT_const_expr:
6886 return "DW_AT_const_expr";
6887 case DW_AT_enum_class:
6888 return "DW_AT_enum_class";
6889 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
6890 return "DW_AT_linkage_name";
6892 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
6893 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
6894 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
6895 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
6896 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
6897 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
6898 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
6899 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
6900 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
6901 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
6902 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
6903 #else
6904 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
6905 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
6906 #endif
6907 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
6908 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
6909 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
6910 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
6911 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
6912 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
6913 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
6914 #else
6915 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
6916 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
6917 #endif
6918 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
6919 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
6920 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
6921 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
6922 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
6923 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
6925 case DW_AT_sf_names:
6926 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
6927 case DW_AT_src_info:
6928 return "DW_AT_src_info";
6929 case DW_AT_mac_info:
6930 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
6931 case DW_AT_src_coords:
6932 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
6933 case DW_AT_body_begin:
6934 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
6935 case DW_AT_body_end:
6936 return "DW_AT_body_end";
6937 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
6938 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
6939 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by:
6940 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by";
6941 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by:
6942 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by";
6943 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded:
6944 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded";
6945 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded:
6946 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded";
6947 case DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded:
6948 return "DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded";
6949 case DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required:
6950 return "DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required";
6951 case DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required:
6952 return "DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required";
6953 case DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature:
6954 return "DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature";
6955 case DW_AT_GNU_template_name:
6956 return "DW_AT_GNU_template_name";
6958 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
6959 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
6961 default:
6962 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
6966 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
6968 static const char *
6969 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
6971 switch (form)
6973 case DW_FORM_addr:
6974 return "DW_FORM_addr";
6975 case DW_FORM_block2:
6976 return "DW_FORM_block2";
6977 case DW_FORM_block4:
6978 return "DW_FORM_block4";
6979 case DW_FORM_data2:
6980 return "DW_FORM_data2";
6981 case DW_FORM_data4:
6982 return "DW_FORM_data4";
6983 case DW_FORM_data8:
6984 return "DW_FORM_data8";
6985 case DW_FORM_string:
6986 return "DW_FORM_string";
6987 case DW_FORM_block:
6988 return "DW_FORM_block";
6989 case DW_FORM_block1:
6990 return "DW_FORM_block1";
6991 case DW_FORM_data1:
6992 return "DW_FORM_data1";
6993 case DW_FORM_flag:
6994 return "DW_FORM_flag";
6995 case DW_FORM_sdata:
6996 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
6997 case DW_FORM_strp:
6998 return "DW_FORM_strp";
6999 case DW_FORM_udata:
7000 return "DW_FORM_udata";
7001 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
7002 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
7003 case DW_FORM_ref1:
7004 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
7005 case DW_FORM_ref2:
7006 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
7007 case DW_FORM_ref4:
7008 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
7009 case DW_FORM_ref8:
7010 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
7011 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
7012 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
7013 case DW_FORM_indirect:
7014 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
7015 case DW_FORM_sec_offset:
7016 return "DW_FORM_sec_offset";
7017 case DW_FORM_exprloc:
7018 return "DW_FORM_exprloc";
7019 case DW_FORM_flag_present:
7020 return "DW_FORM_flag_present";
7021 case DW_FORM_ref_sig8:
7022 return "DW_FORM_ref_sig8";
7023 default:
7024 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
7028 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
7029 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
7030 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
7031 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
7032 given block. */
7034 static tree
7035 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
7037 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
7038 return NULL_TREE;
7040 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
7041 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
7042 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
7043 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
7044 return NULL_TREE;
7046 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
7047 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
7048 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
7050 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
7053 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
7054 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
7055 parameter. */
7057 static tree
7058 decl_class_context (tree decl)
7060 tree context = NULL_TREE;
7062 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
7063 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
7064 else
7065 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
7066 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
7068 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
7069 context = NULL_TREE;
7071 return context;
7074 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
7076 static inline void
7077 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
7079 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
7080 if (die == NULL)
7081 return;
7083 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
7084 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
7085 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
7088 static inline enum dw_val_class
7089 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
7091 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
7094 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
7096 static inline void
7097 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
7099 dw_attr_node attr;
7101 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7102 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
7103 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
7104 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7107 static inline unsigned
7108 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
7110 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
7111 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
7114 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7116 static inline void
7117 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
7119 dw_attr_node attr;
7121 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7122 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
7123 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
7124 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7127 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
7128 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
7130 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
7131 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
7134 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7136 static inline void
7137 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7138 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
7140 dw_attr_node attr;
7142 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7143 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
7144 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
7145 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7148 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7149 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
7151 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
7152 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
7155 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7157 static inline void
7158 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7159 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
7161 dw_attr_node attr;
7163 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7164 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
7165 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
7166 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
7167 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7170 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
7172 static inline void
7173 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7174 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
7176 dw_attr_node attr;
7178 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7179 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
7180 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
7181 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
7182 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
7183 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7186 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
7188 static inline void
7189 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7190 unsigned char data8[8])
7192 dw_attr_node attr;
7194 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7195 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
7196 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
7197 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7200 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
7202 static hashval_t
7203 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
7205 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
7208 static int
7209 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
7211 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
7212 (const char *)x2) == 0;
7215 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
7217 static struct indirect_string_node *
7218 find_AT_string (const char *str)
7220 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7221 void **slot;
7223 if (! debug_str_hash)
7224 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
7225 debug_str_eq, NULL);
7227 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
7228 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
7229 if (*slot == NULL)
7231 node = ggc_alloc_cleared_indirect_string_node ();
7232 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
7233 *slot = node;
7235 else
7236 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
7238 node->refcount++;
7239 return node;
7242 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
7244 static inline void
7245 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
7247 dw_attr_node attr;
7248 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7250 node = find_AT_string (str);
7252 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7253 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
7254 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
7255 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7258 /* Create a label for an indirect string node, ensuring it is going to
7259 be output, unless its reference count goes down to zero. */
7261 static inline void
7262 gen_label_for_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
7264 char label[32];
7266 if (node->label)
7267 return;
7269 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
7270 ++dw2_string_counter;
7271 node->label = xstrdup (label);
7274 /* Create a SYMBOL_REF rtx whose value is the initial address of a
7275 debug string STR. */
7277 static inline rtx
7278 get_debug_string_label (const char *str)
7280 struct indirect_string_node *node = find_AT_string (str);
7282 debug_str_hash_forced = true;
7284 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7286 return gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, node->label);
7289 static inline const char *
7290 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
7292 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7293 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
7296 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
7297 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
7299 static enum dwarf_form
7300 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
7302 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7303 unsigned int len;
7305 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7307 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
7308 if (node->form)
7309 return node->form;
7311 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
7313 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
7314 always better to put it inline. */
7315 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
7316 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7318 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
7319 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
7320 single module. */
7321 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
7322 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
7323 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
7324 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7326 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7328 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
7331 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7333 static inline void
7334 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7336 dw_attr_node attr;
7338 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7339 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
7340 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
7341 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
7342 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7345 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
7346 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
7348 static inline void
7349 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7351 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
7352 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
7353 targ_die->die_definition = die;
7356 static inline dw_die_ref
7357 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
7359 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7360 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
7363 static inline int
7364 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
7366 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7367 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
7369 return 0;
7372 static inline void
7373 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
7375 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7376 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
7379 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7381 static inline void
7382 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
7384 dw_attr_node attr;
7386 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7387 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
7388 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
7389 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7392 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
7394 static inline void
7395 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
7397 dw_attr_node attr;
7399 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7400 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
7401 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
7402 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7405 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
7406 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
7408 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7409 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
7412 static inline void
7413 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
7415 dw_attr_node attr;
7417 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7418 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
7419 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
7420 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7421 have_location_lists = true;
7424 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7425 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
7427 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7428 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7431 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
7432 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_ref a)
7434 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7435 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7438 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
7440 static inline void
7441 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
7443 dw_attr_node attr;
7445 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7446 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7447 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
7448 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7451 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
7453 static inline rtx
7454 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
7456 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
7457 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
7460 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
7462 static inline void
7463 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7464 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
7466 dw_attr_node attr;
7468 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7469 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
7470 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
7471 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7474 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
7476 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7477 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
7479 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
7480 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
7483 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
7485 static inline void
7486 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7487 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
7489 dw_attr_node attr;
7491 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7492 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
7493 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
7494 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
7495 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7498 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
7500 static inline void
7501 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
7503 dw_attr_node attr;
7505 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7506 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
7507 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
7508 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7511 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7512 debug_line section. */
7514 static inline void
7515 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7516 const char *label)
7518 dw_attr_node attr;
7520 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7521 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
7522 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7523 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7526 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7527 debug_macinfo section. */
7529 static inline void
7530 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7531 const char *label)
7533 dw_attr_node attr;
7535 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7536 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
7537 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7538 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7541 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
7543 static inline void
7544 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7545 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7547 dw_attr_node attr;
7549 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7550 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
7551 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7552 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7555 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
7557 static void
7558 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7559 long unsigned int offset)
7561 dw_attr_node attr;
7563 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7564 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
7565 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7566 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7569 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
7571 static inline const char *
7572 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref a)
7574 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7575 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
7578 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
7580 static inline const char *
7581 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref a)
7583 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7584 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
7587 static inline const char *
7588 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
7590 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
7591 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
7592 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
7593 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
7596 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
7598 static dw_attr_ref
7599 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7601 dw_attr_ref a;
7602 unsigned ix;
7603 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
7605 if (! die)
7606 return NULL;
7608 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7609 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7610 return a;
7611 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
7612 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7613 spec = AT_ref (a);
7615 if (spec)
7616 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
7618 return NULL;
7621 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7622 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7623 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7625 static inline const char *
7626 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7628 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
7630 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7633 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7634 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7635 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7637 static inline const char *
7638 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7640 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
7642 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7645 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
7646 NULL if it is not present. */
7648 static inline const char *
7649 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7651 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7653 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
7656 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
7657 if it is not present. */
7659 static inline int
7660 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7662 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7664 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
7667 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
7668 if it is not present. */
7670 static inline unsigned
7671 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7673 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7675 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
7678 static inline dw_die_ref
7679 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7681 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7683 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
7686 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7687 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7689 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7691 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
7694 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
7696 static inline bool
7697 is_cxx (void)
7699 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
7701 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
7704 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
7706 static inline bool
7707 is_fortran (void)
7709 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
7711 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
7712 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
7713 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
7716 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
7718 static inline bool
7719 is_ada (void)
7721 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
7723 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
7726 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
7728 static void
7729 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7731 dw_attr_ref a;
7732 unsigned ix;
7734 if (! die)
7735 return;
7737 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7738 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7740 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
7741 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
7742 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
7744 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
7745 that are needed. */
7746 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
7747 return;
7751 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
7752 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
7754 static void
7755 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
7757 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
7758 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
7759 if (prev == child)
7761 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
7762 prev = NULL;
7764 else
7765 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
7766 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
7767 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
7770 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
7771 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
7773 static void
7774 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
7776 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
7778 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
7779 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
7781 new_child->die_parent = parent;
7782 if (prev == old_child)
7784 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
7785 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
7787 else
7789 prev->die_sib = new_child;
7790 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
7792 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
7793 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
7796 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
7798 static void
7799 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
7801 dw_die_ref c;
7802 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
7803 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
7804 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
7807 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
7808 matches TAG. */
7810 static void
7811 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
7813 dw_die_ref c;
7815 c = die->die_child;
7816 if (c) do {
7817 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7818 c = c->die_sib;
7819 while (c->die_tag == tag)
7821 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7822 /* Might have removed every child. */
7823 if (c == c->die_sib)
7824 return;
7825 c = c->die_sib;
7827 } while (c != die->die_child);
7830 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
7832 static void
7833 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
7835 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
7836 if (! die || ! child_die)
7837 return;
7838 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
7840 child_die->die_parent = die;
7841 if (die->die_child)
7843 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
7844 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
7846 else
7847 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
7848 die->die_child = child_die;
7851 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
7852 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
7853 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
7855 static void
7856 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
7858 dw_die_ref p;
7860 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
7861 specification DIE at toplevel. */
7862 if (child->die_parent != parent)
7864 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
7866 if (tmp)
7867 child = tmp;
7870 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
7871 || (child->die_parent
7872 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
7874 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
7875 if (p->die_sib == child)
7877 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
7878 break;
7881 add_child_die (parent, child);
7884 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
7886 static inline dw_die_ref
7887 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
7889 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
7891 die->die_tag = tag_value;
7893 if (parent_die != NULL)
7894 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
7895 else
7897 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
7899 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
7900 limbo_node->die = die;
7901 limbo_node->created_for = t;
7902 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
7903 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
7906 return die;
7909 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
7911 static inline dw_die_ref
7912 lookup_type_die (tree type)
7914 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
7917 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
7919 static inline void
7920 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
7922 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
7925 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
7927 static hashval_t
7928 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
7930 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
7933 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
7935 static int
7936 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7938 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7941 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
7943 static inline dw_die_ref
7944 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
7946 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7949 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
7951 static hashval_t
7952 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
7954 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
7957 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
7958 UID of decl *Y. */
7960 static int
7961 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7963 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7966 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
7968 static inline var_loc_list *
7969 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
7971 if (!decl_loc_table)
7972 return NULL;
7973 return (var_loc_list *)
7974 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7977 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
7979 static void
7980 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
7982 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7983 void **slot;
7985 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7986 *slot = decl_die;
7987 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
7990 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
7992 static int
7993 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
7995 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
7996 if (ret)
7997 return ret;
7998 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
7999 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
8000 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
8003 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
8005 static rtx *
8006 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
8008 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
8009 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
8010 else
8011 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
8014 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
8015 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
8017 static rtx
8018 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
8020 if (bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
8021 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
8022 else
8023 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
8024 GEN_INT (bitsize),
8025 loc_note), next);
8028 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
8029 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
8031 static rtx
8032 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
8033 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
8035 if (bitsize != -1)
8037 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
8038 if (bitpos != 0)
8039 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
8041 return loc_note;
8044 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
8045 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
8046 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
8047 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
8048 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
8049 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
8050 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
8051 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
8052 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
8054 static void
8055 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
8056 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
8057 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
8059 int diff;
8060 bool copy = inner != NULL;
8062 if (copy)
8064 /* First copy all nodes preceeding the current bitpos. */
8065 while (src != inner)
8067 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
8068 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
8069 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8070 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8073 /* Add padding if needed. */
8074 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
8076 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
8077 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8078 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8080 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
8082 gcc_assert (!copy);
8083 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
8084 just update the location for it and return. */
8085 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
8086 return;
8088 /* Add the piece that changed. */
8089 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8090 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8091 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
8092 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
8093 if (!copy)
8094 src = dest;
8095 while (diff > 0 && *src)
8097 rtx piece = *src;
8098 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
8099 if (copy)
8100 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
8101 else
8103 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
8104 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
8107 /* Add padding if needed. */
8108 if (diff < 0 && *src)
8110 if (!copy)
8111 dest = src;
8112 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8113 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8115 if (!copy)
8116 return;
8117 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
8118 while (*src)
8120 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
8121 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
8122 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8123 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8127 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
8129 static struct var_loc_node *
8130 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
8132 unsigned int decl_id;
8133 var_loc_list *temp;
8134 void **slot;
8135 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
8136 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
8138 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl))
8140 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
8141 if (realdecl && handled_component_p (realdecl))
8143 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
8144 tree innerdecl;
8145 innerdecl
8146 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize);
8147 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
8148 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
8149 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
8150 || bitsize <= 0
8151 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
8152 || bitsize != maxsize)
8153 return NULL;
8154 decl = innerdecl;
8158 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
8159 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
8160 if (*slot == NULL)
8162 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_list ();
8163 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
8164 *slot = temp;
8166 else
8167 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
8169 if (temp->last)
8171 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
8172 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
8173 int piece_bitpos = 0;
8174 if (last->next)
8176 last = last->next;
8177 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
8179 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
8181 piece_loc = &last->loc;
8184 int cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
8185 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
8186 break;
8187 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
8188 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
8190 while (*piece_loc);
8192 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
8193 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
8194 last element. */
8195 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
8197 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
8198 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
8199 if (piece_loc != NULL)
8201 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
8202 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8203 return NULL;
8205 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
8206 if (temp->last != last)
8208 temp->last->next = NULL;
8209 unused = last;
8210 last = temp->last;
8211 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
8213 else
8215 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last);
8216 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
8217 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8218 return temp->last;
8221 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
8222 last_loc_note = last->loc;
8223 else if (piece_loc != NULL
8224 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
8225 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
8226 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
8227 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
8228 else
8229 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
8230 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
8231 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
8232 we have nothing to do. */
8233 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
8234 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
8235 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
8236 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8237 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
8238 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8239 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
8240 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
8241 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
8243 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
8244 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
8245 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
8246 if (unused)
8248 loc = unused;
8249 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
8251 else
8252 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8253 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
8254 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8255 else
8256 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
8257 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8258 last->next = loc;
8259 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
8260 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
8261 if (last != temp->last)
8262 temp->last = last;
8264 else if (unused)
8265 ggc_free (unused);
8267 else
8269 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8270 temp->first = loc;
8271 temp->last = loc;
8272 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8274 return loc;
8277 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
8278 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
8279 the DIE internal representation. */
8280 static int print_indent;
8282 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
8284 static inline void
8285 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
8287 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
8290 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
8292 static inline void
8293 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
8295 int i;
8297 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8298 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
8301 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
8302 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8304 static void
8305 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
8307 dw_attr_ref a;
8308 dw_die_ref c;
8309 unsigned ix;
8311 print_spaces (outfile);
8312 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
8313 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
8314 print_spaces (outfile);
8315 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
8316 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
8317 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && die->die_id.die_type_node)
8319 print_spaces (outfile);
8320 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
8321 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8322 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8325 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8327 print_spaces (outfile);
8328 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
8330 switch (AT_class (a))
8332 case dw_val_class_addr:
8333 fprintf (outfile, "address");
8334 break;
8335 case dw_val_class_offset:
8336 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
8337 break;
8338 case dw_val_class_loc:
8339 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
8340 break;
8341 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8342 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
8343 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
8344 break;
8345 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8346 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
8347 break;
8348 case dw_val_class_const:
8349 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
8350 break;
8351 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8352 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
8353 break;
8354 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8355 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
8356 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
8357 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
8358 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
8359 break;
8360 case dw_val_class_vec:
8361 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
8362 break;
8363 case dw_val_class_flag:
8364 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
8365 break;
8366 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8367 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
8369 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node)
8371 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
8372 print_signature (outfile,
8373 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8375 else if (dwarf_version < 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
8376 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
8377 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8378 else
8379 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
8381 else
8382 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
8383 break;
8384 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8385 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
8386 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a));
8387 break;
8388 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8389 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8390 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8391 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
8392 break;
8393 case dw_val_class_str:
8394 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
8395 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
8396 else
8397 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
8398 break;
8399 case dw_val_class_file:
8400 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
8401 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
8402 break;
8403 case dw_val_class_data8:
8405 int i;
8407 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8408 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
8409 break;
8411 default:
8412 break;
8415 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8418 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8420 print_indent += 4;
8421 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
8422 print_indent -= 4;
8424 if (print_indent == 0)
8425 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8428 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
8429 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8431 static void
8432 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
8434 unsigned i;
8435 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
8437 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
8438 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
8440 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
8441 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
8442 line_info->dw_file_num,
8443 line_info->dw_line_num);
8446 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
8449 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
8451 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8452 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
8454 print_die (die, stderr);
8457 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
8458 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8460 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8461 debug_dwarf (void)
8463 print_indent = 0;
8464 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
8465 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
8466 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
8469 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
8470 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
8471 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
8473 static dw_die_ref
8474 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
8476 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
8477 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
8479 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
8480 return new_unit;
8483 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
8485 static dw_die_ref
8486 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
8488 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
8490 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
8491 return new_unit;
8494 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8495 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
8497 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8499 static inline void
8500 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8502 int tem;
8504 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
8505 CHECKSUM (tem);
8506 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8507 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8510 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8512 static void
8513 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8515 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8516 rtx r;
8518 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
8520 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8521 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8522 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8523 return;
8525 switch (AT_class (at))
8527 case dw_val_class_const:
8528 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8529 break;
8530 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8531 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8532 break;
8533 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8534 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8535 break;
8536 case dw_val_class_vec:
8537 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8538 break;
8539 case dw_val_class_flag:
8540 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
8541 break;
8542 case dw_val_class_str:
8543 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8544 break;
8546 case dw_val_class_addr:
8547 r = AT_addr (at);
8548 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8549 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8550 break;
8552 case dw_val_class_offset:
8553 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8554 break;
8556 case dw_val_class_loc:
8557 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8558 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
8559 break;
8561 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8562 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
8563 break;
8565 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8566 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8567 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8568 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8569 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8570 break;
8572 case dw_val_class_file:
8573 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8574 break;
8576 case dw_val_class_data8:
8577 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8578 break;
8580 default:
8581 break;
8585 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
8587 static void
8588 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8590 dw_die_ref c;
8591 dw_attr_ref a;
8592 unsigned ix;
8594 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8595 if (die->die_mark)
8597 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
8598 return;
8600 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8602 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
8604 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8605 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
8607 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
8610 #undef CHECKSUM
8611 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8613 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
8614 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8615 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
8616 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8617 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8618 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
8619 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
8621 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
8623 static void
8624 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8626 unsigned char byte;
8627 bool more;
8629 while (1)
8631 byte = (value & 0x7f);
8632 value >>= 7;
8633 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
8634 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
8635 if (more)
8636 byte |= 0x80;
8637 CHECKSUM (byte);
8638 if (!more)
8639 break;
8643 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
8645 static void
8646 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8648 while (1)
8650 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
8651 value >>= 7;
8652 if (value != 0)
8653 /* More bytes to follow. */
8654 byte |= 0x80;
8655 CHECKSUM (byte);
8656 if (value == 0)
8657 break;
8661 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
8662 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
8664 static void
8665 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8667 const char *name;
8668 dw_die_ref spec;
8669 int tag = die->die_tag;
8671 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
8672 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
8673 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
8674 return;
8676 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8678 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8679 if (spec != NULL)
8680 die = spec;
8682 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
8683 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
8685 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
8686 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
8687 if (name != NULL)
8688 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
8691 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8693 static inline void
8694 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8696 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
8697 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
8698 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
8700 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8701 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
8702 return;
8705 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
8706 while (loc != NULL)
8708 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
8709 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8710 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8711 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
8715 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8717 static void
8718 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
8719 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8721 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8722 rtx r;
8724 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8726 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
8728 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
8729 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
8730 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
8731 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
8732 is complete or not. */
8733 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
8734 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
8735 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
8736 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
8737 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
8738 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
8739 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
8741 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
8743 if (name_attr != NULL)
8745 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8747 if (decl == NULL)
8748 decl = target_die;
8749 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
8750 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8751 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8752 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8753 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
8754 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8755 return;
8759 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
8760 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
8761 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
8762 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
8764 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
8765 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8766 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
8768 else
8770 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8772 if (decl == NULL)
8773 decl = target_die;
8774 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8775 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
8776 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8777 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8778 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8779 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
8781 return;
8784 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
8785 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8787 switch (AT_class (at))
8789 case dw_val_class_const:
8790 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8791 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8792 break;
8794 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8795 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8796 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8797 break;
8799 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8800 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8801 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
8802 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8803 break;
8805 case dw_val_class_vec:
8806 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8807 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
8808 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8809 break;
8811 case dw_val_class_flag:
8812 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
8813 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
8814 break;
8816 case dw_val_class_str:
8817 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8818 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8819 break;
8821 case dw_val_class_addr:
8822 r = AT_addr (at);
8823 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8824 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8825 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8826 break;
8828 case dw_val_class_offset:
8829 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8830 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8831 break;
8833 case dw_val_class_loc:
8834 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8835 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
8836 break;
8838 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8839 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8840 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8841 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8842 break;
8844 case dw_val_class_file:
8845 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8846 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8847 break;
8849 case dw_val_class_data8:
8850 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8851 break;
8853 default:
8854 break;
8858 struct checksum_attributes
8860 dw_attr_ref at_name;
8861 dw_attr_ref at_type;
8862 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
8863 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
8864 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
8865 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
8866 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
8867 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
8868 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
8869 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
8870 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
8871 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
8872 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
8873 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
8874 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
8875 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
8876 dw_attr_ref at_count;
8877 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
8878 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
8879 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
8880 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
8881 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
8882 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
8883 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
8884 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
8885 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
8886 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
8887 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
8888 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
8889 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
8890 dw_attr_ref at_location;
8891 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
8892 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
8893 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
8894 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
8895 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
8896 dw_attr_ref at_small;
8897 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
8898 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
8899 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
8900 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
8901 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
8902 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
8903 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
8904 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
8905 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
8906 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
8909 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
8911 static void
8912 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
8914 dw_attr_ref a;
8915 unsigned ix;
8917 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8919 switch (a->dw_attr)
8921 case DW_AT_name:
8922 attrs->at_name = a;
8923 break;
8924 case DW_AT_type:
8925 attrs->at_type = a;
8926 break;
8927 case DW_AT_friend:
8928 attrs->at_friend = a;
8929 break;
8930 case DW_AT_accessibility:
8931 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
8932 break;
8933 case DW_AT_address_class:
8934 attrs->at_address_class = a;
8935 break;
8936 case DW_AT_allocated:
8937 attrs->at_allocated = a;
8938 break;
8939 case DW_AT_artificial:
8940 attrs->at_artificial = a;
8941 break;
8942 case DW_AT_associated:
8943 attrs->at_associated = a;
8944 break;
8945 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
8946 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
8947 break;
8948 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
8949 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
8950 break;
8951 case DW_AT_bit_size:
8952 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
8953 break;
8954 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
8955 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
8956 break;
8957 case DW_AT_byte_size:
8958 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
8959 break;
8960 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
8961 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
8962 break;
8963 case DW_AT_const_value:
8964 attrs->at_const_value = a;
8965 break;
8966 case DW_AT_containing_type:
8967 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
8968 break;
8969 case DW_AT_count:
8970 attrs->at_count = a;
8971 break;
8972 case DW_AT_data_location:
8973 attrs->at_data_location = a;
8974 break;
8975 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
8976 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
8977 break;
8978 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
8979 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
8980 break;
8981 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
8982 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
8983 break;
8984 case DW_AT_default_value:
8985 attrs->at_default_value = a;
8986 break;
8987 case DW_AT_digit_count:
8988 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
8989 break;
8990 case DW_AT_discr:
8991 attrs->at_discr = a;
8992 break;
8993 case DW_AT_discr_list:
8994 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
8995 break;
8996 case DW_AT_discr_value:
8997 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
8998 break;
8999 case DW_AT_encoding:
9000 attrs->at_encoding = a;
9001 break;
9002 case DW_AT_endianity:
9003 attrs->at_endianity = a;
9004 break;
9005 case DW_AT_explicit:
9006 attrs->at_explicit = a;
9007 break;
9008 case DW_AT_is_optional:
9009 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
9010 break;
9011 case DW_AT_location:
9012 attrs->at_location = a;
9013 break;
9014 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
9015 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
9016 break;
9017 case DW_AT_mutable:
9018 attrs->at_mutable = a;
9019 break;
9020 case DW_AT_ordering:
9021 attrs->at_ordering = a;
9022 break;
9023 case DW_AT_picture_string:
9024 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
9025 break;
9026 case DW_AT_prototyped:
9027 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
9028 break;
9029 case DW_AT_small:
9030 attrs->at_small = a;
9031 break;
9032 case DW_AT_segment:
9033 attrs->at_segment = a;
9034 break;
9035 case DW_AT_string_length:
9036 attrs->at_string_length = a;
9037 break;
9038 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
9039 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
9040 break;
9041 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
9042 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
9043 break;
9044 case DW_AT_use_location:
9045 attrs->at_use_location = a;
9046 break;
9047 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
9048 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
9049 break;
9050 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
9051 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
9052 break;
9053 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9054 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
9055 break;
9056 case DW_AT_visibility:
9057 attrs->at_visibility = a;
9058 break;
9059 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
9060 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
9061 break;
9062 default:
9063 break;
9068 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
9070 static void
9071 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
9073 dw_die_ref c;
9074 dw_die_ref decl;
9075 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
9077 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
9078 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
9080 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
9082 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9083 if (decl != NULL)
9084 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
9085 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
9087 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
9088 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
9089 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
9090 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
9091 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
9092 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
9093 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
9094 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
9095 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
9096 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
9097 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
9098 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
9099 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
9100 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
9101 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
9102 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
9103 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
9104 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
9105 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
9106 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
9107 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
9108 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
9109 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
9110 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
9111 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
9112 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
9113 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
9114 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
9115 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
9116 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
9117 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
9118 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
9119 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
9120 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
9121 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
9122 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
9123 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
9124 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
9125 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
9126 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
9127 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
9128 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
9129 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
9130 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
9131 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
9132 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
9133 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
9135 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
9136 c = die->die_child;
9137 if (c) do {
9138 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
9140 c = c->die_sib;
9141 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
9142 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
9143 && name_attr != NULL)
9145 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
9146 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
9147 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
9149 else
9151 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
9152 if (c->die_mark == 0)
9153 c->die_mark = -1;
9154 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
9156 } while (c != die->die_child);
9158 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
9161 #undef CHECKSUM
9162 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
9163 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
9164 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
9165 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
9167 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
9168 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
9169 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
9170 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
9171 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
9172 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
9173 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
9175 static void
9176 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
9178 int mark;
9179 const char *name;
9180 unsigned char checksum[16];
9181 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9182 dw_die_ref decl;
9184 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
9185 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9187 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
9188 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
9189 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
9191 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
9193 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9195 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9196 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9197 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9199 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
9200 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
9201 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9203 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
9206 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
9208 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9209 mark = 1;
9210 die->die_mark = mark;
9212 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9213 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9214 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9216 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
9217 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
9218 unmark_all_dies (die);
9219 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9221 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
9222 type node together. */
9223 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
9224 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
9225 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9226 type_node->type_die = die;
9228 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
9229 as well. */
9230 if (decl != NULL)
9231 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9234 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
9235 static inline int
9236 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
9238 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
9239 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
9240 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
9243 /* Do the values look the same? */
9244 static int
9245 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
9247 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
9248 rtx r1, r2;
9250 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
9251 return 0;
9253 switch (v1->val_class)
9255 case dw_val_class_const:
9256 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
9257 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9258 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
9259 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9260 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
9261 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
9262 case dw_val_class_vec:
9263 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
9264 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
9265 return 0;
9266 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
9267 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
9268 return 0;
9269 return 1;
9270 case dw_val_class_flag:
9271 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
9272 case dw_val_class_str:
9273 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
9275 case dw_val_class_addr:
9276 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
9277 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
9278 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
9279 return 0;
9280 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
9282 case dw_val_class_offset:
9283 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
9285 case dw_val_class_loc:
9286 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
9287 loc1 && loc2;
9288 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
9289 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
9290 return 0;
9291 return !loc1 && !loc2;
9293 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9294 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
9296 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9297 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9298 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9299 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9300 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9301 return 1;
9303 case dw_val_class_file:
9304 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
9306 case dw_val_class_data8:
9307 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
9309 default:
9310 return 1;
9314 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
9316 static int
9317 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
9319 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
9320 return 0;
9322 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
9323 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
9324 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
9325 return 1;
9327 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
9330 /* Do the dies look the same? */
9332 static int
9333 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
9335 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
9336 dw_attr_ref a1;
9337 unsigned ix;
9339 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
9340 if (die1->die_mark)
9341 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
9342 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
9344 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
9345 return 0;
9347 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
9348 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
9349 return 0;
9351 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
9352 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
9353 return 0;
9355 c1 = die1->die_child;
9356 c2 = die2->die_child;
9357 if (! c1)
9359 if (c2)
9360 return 0;
9362 else
9363 for (;;)
9365 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
9366 return 0;
9367 c1 = c1->die_sib;
9368 c2 = c2->die_sib;
9369 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
9371 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
9372 break;
9373 else
9374 return 0;
9378 return 1;
9381 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
9383 static int
9384 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
9386 int mark = 0;
9387 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
9389 unmark_all_dies (die1);
9390 unmark_all_dies (die2);
9392 return ret;
9395 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
9396 info section. */
9397 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
9399 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
9400 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
9402 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
9403 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
9405 static void
9406 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
9408 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
9409 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
9410 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
9411 char *p;
9412 int i, mark;
9413 unsigned char checksum[16];
9414 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9416 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
9417 the name filename of the unit. */
9419 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9420 mark = 0;
9421 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
9422 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
9423 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9425 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
9426 clean_symbol_name (name);
9428 p = name + strlen (name);
9429 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
9431 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
9432 p += 2;
9435 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
9436 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
9439 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
9441 static int
9442 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
9444 switch (die->die_tag)
9446 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9447 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9448 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9449 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9450 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9451 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9452 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
9453 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9454 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9455 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9456 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9457 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9458 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9459 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9460 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9461 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9462 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9463 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9464 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9465 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9466 return 1;
9467 default:
9468 return 0;
9472 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
9473 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
9474 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
9475 compilations (functions). */
9477 static int
9478 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
9480 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
9481 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
9482 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
9483 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
9485 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9486 return 0;
9488 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9489 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9490 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
9491 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
9492 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
9494 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
9496 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
9499 return is_type_die (c);
9502 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
9503 compilation unit. */
9505 static int
9506 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
9508 return (is_type_die (c)
9509 || is_declaration_die (c)
9510 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9511 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
9514 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
9516 static inline bool
9517 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
9519 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
9522 static char *
9523 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
9525 char buf[256];
9527 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
9528 return xstrdup (buf);
9531 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
9533 static void
9534 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
9536 dw_die_ref c;
9538 if (is_symbol_die (die))
9540 if (comdat_symbol_id)
9542 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
9544 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
9545 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
9546 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
9548 else
9549 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
9552 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
9555 struct cu_hash_table_entry
9557 dw_die_ref cu;
9558 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
9559 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
9562 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
9563 static hashval_t
9564 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
9566 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
9567 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
9569 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
9572 static int
9573 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9575 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
9576 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
9577 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9579 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
9582 static void
9583 htab_cu_del (void *what)
9585 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
9586 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
9588 while (entry)
9590 next = entry->next;
9591 free (entry);
9592 entry = next;
9596 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
9597 accordingly. */
9598 static int
9599 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
9601 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
9602 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
9604 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
9606 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9607 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9608 INSERT);
9609 entry = *slot;
9611 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
9613 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
9614 break;
9617 if (entry)
9619 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
9620 return 1;
9623 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
9624 entry->cu = cu;
9625 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
9626 entry->next = *slot;
9627 *slot = entry;
9629 return 0;
9632 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
9633 static void
9634 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
9636 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
9638 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9639 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9640 NO_INSERT);
9641 entry = *slot;
9643 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
9646 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
9647 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
9648 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
9650 static void
9651 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
9653 dw_die_ref c;
9654 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9655 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
9656 htab_t cu_hash_table;
9658 c = die->die_child;
9659 if (c) do {
9660 dw_die_ref prev = c;
9661 c = c->die_sib;
9662 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
9663 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
9665 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
9667 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
9668 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
9670 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
9671 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
9672 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
9673 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
9674 else
9675 add_child_die (unit, c);
9676 c = next;
9677 if (c == die->die_child)
9678 break;
9680 } while (c != die->die_child);
9682 #if 0
9683 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
9684 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
9685 gcc_assert (!unit);
9686 #endif
9688 assign_symbol_names (die);
9689 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
9690 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
9691 node;
9692 node = node->next)
9694 int is_dupl;
9696 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
9697 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9698 &comdat_symbol_number);
9699 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
9700 if (is_dupl)
9701 *pnode = node->next;
9702 else
9704 pnode = &node->next;
9705 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9706 comdat_symbol_number);
9709 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
9712 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
9714 static int
9715 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
9717 dw_attr_ref a;
9718 unsigned ix;
9720 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
9721 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
9722 return 1;
9724 return 0;
9727 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
9729 static int
9730 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
9732 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9734 if (decl == NULL)
9735 decl = die;
9736 return local_scope_p (decl);
9739 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
9740 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
9742 static int
9743 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
9745 switch (die->die_tag)
9747 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9748 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9749 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9750 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9751 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, or types nested in a
9752 subprogram. */
9753 if (is_declaration_die (die)
9754 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
9755 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die))
9756 return 0;
9757 return 1;
9758 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9759 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9760 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9761 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9762 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
9763 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9764 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9765 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9766 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9767 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9768 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9769 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9770 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9771 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9772 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9773 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9774 default:
9775 return 0;
9779 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
9781 static dw_die_ref
9782 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
9784 dw_die_ref clone;
9785 dw_attr_ref a;
9786 unsigned ix;
9788 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
9789 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9791 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
9792 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9794 return clone;
9797 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
9799 static dw_die_ref
9800 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
9802 dw_die_ref c;
9803 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
9805 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
9807 return clone;
9810 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
9812 static dw_die_ref
9813 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
9815 dw_die_ref clone;
9816 dw_die_ref decl;
9817 dw_attr_ref a;
9818 unsigned ix;
9820 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
9821 if (is_declaration_die (die))
9822 return clone_die (die);
9824 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
9825 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9826 if (decl != NULL)
9827 return clone_die (decl);
9829 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
9830 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9832 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
9834 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
9835 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
9836 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
9838 switch (a->dw_attr)
9840 case DW_AT_artificial:
9841 case DW_AT_containing_type:
9842 case DW_AT_external:
9843 case DW_AT_name:
9844 case DW_AT_type:
9845 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9846 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
9847 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
9848 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9849 break;
9850 case DW_AT_byte_size:
9851 default:
9852 break;
9856 if (die->die_id.die_type_node)
9857 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
9859 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9860 return clone;
9863 /* Copy the declaration context to the new compile unit DIE. This includes
9864 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
9865 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
9866 attached to the specification. */
9868 static void
9869 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
9871 dw_die_ref decl;
9872 dw_die_ref new_decl;
9874 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9875 if (decl == NULL)
9876 decl = die;
9877 else
9879 unsigned ix;
9880 dw_die_ref c;
9881 dw_attr_ref a;
9883 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
9884 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
9885 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
9887 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
9889 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a)
9891 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
9892 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
9893 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
9894 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
9897 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
9900 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
9901 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9902 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9904 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
9905 if (new_decl != NULL)
9907 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
9908 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
9913 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
9914 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
9916 static void
9917 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
9919 if (node->new_die != NULL)
9920 return;
9922 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
9924 if (node->parent != NULL)
9926 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
9927 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
9931 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
9932 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
9933 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
9935 static void
9936 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
9938 skeleton_chain_node node;
9939 dw_die_ref c;
9940 dw_die_ref first;
9941 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9942 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9944 node.parent = parent;
9946 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
9947 if (c)
9948 next = c->die_sib;
9949 if (c) do {
9950 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9951 prev = c;
9952 c = next;
9953 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9954 node.old_die = c;
9955 node.new_die = NULL;
9956 if (is_declaration_die (c))
9958 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
9959 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
9960 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
9961 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
9962 move_all_children (c, clone);
9964 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
9965 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
9966 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
9967 node.new_die = c;
9968 c = clone;
9970 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9971 } while (next != NULL);
9974 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
9976 static dw_die_ref
9977 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
9979 skeleton_chain_node node;
9981 node.old_die = die;
9982 node.new_die = NULL;
9983 node.parent = NULL;
9985 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
9986 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
9987 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
9988 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
9990 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9991 return node.new_die;
9994 /* Remove the DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
9995 declaration. The original DIE will be moved to a new compile unit
9996 so that existing references to it follow it to the new location. If
9997 any of the original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to
9998 replace the original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the
9999 declarations back into the skeleton tree. */
10001 static dw_die_ref
10002 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
10004 dw_die_ref skeleton;
10006 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
10007 if (skeleton == NULL)
10008 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
10009 else
10011 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
10012 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
10015 return skeleton;
10018 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
10019 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
10021 static void
10022 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
10024 dw_die_ref c;
10025 dw_die_ref first;
10026 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
10027 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
10028 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
10030 first = c = die->die_child;
10031 if (c)
10032 next = c->die_sib;
10033 if (c) do {
10034 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
10035 prev = c;
10036 c = next;
10037 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
10038 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
10040 dw_die_ref replacement;
10041 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
10043 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
10044 add it to the list of comdat types. */
10045 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
10046 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
10047 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
10048 type_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_comdat_type_node ();
10049 type_node->root_die = unit;
10050 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
10051 comdat_type_list = type_node;
10053 /* Generate the type signature. */
10054 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
10056 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
10057 declaration into the new compile unit DIE. */
10058 copy_declaration_context (unit, c);
10060 /* Remove this DIE from the main CU. */
10061 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (c, prev);
10063 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
10064 break_out_comdat_types (c);
10066 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
10067 add_child_die (unit, c);
10069 if (replacement != NULL)
10070 c = replacement;
10072 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
10073 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
10074 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10075 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
10077 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
10078 break_out_comdat_types (c);
10080 } while (next != NULL);
10083 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
10085 struct decl_table_entry
10087 dw_die_ref orig;
10088 dw_die_ref copy;
10091 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
10093 static hashval_t
10094 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
10096 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
10097 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
10099 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
10102 static int
10103 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
10105 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
10106 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
10107 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
10109 return entry1->orig == entry2;
10112 static void
10113 htab_decl_del (void *what)
10115 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
10117 free (entry);
10120 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
10121 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
10122 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
10123 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
10125 static dw_die_ref
10126 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10128 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
10129 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
10130 dw_die_ref copy;
10131 void **slot = NULL;
10132 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
10134 if (decl_table)
10136 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
10137 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
10138 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
10139 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10141 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10142 return entry->copy;
10145 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
10146 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10147 entry->orig = die;
10148 entry->copy = NULL;
10149 *slot = entry;
10152 if (parent != NULL)
10154 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
10155 if (spec != NULL)
10156 parent = spec;
10157 if (parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10158 && parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10159 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
10162 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
10163 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
10165 if (decl_table != NULL)
10167 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
10168 entry->copy = copy;
10171 return copy;
10174 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
10175 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
10176 type_unit). */
10178 static void
10179 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10181 dw_die_ref c;
10182 dw_attr_ref a;
10183 unsigned ix;
10185 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10187 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10189 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
10190 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = targ->die_id.die_type_node;
10191 void **slot;
10192 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
10194 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || type_node != NULL)
10195 continue;
10197 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
10198 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
10200 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10202 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
10203 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
10204 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10205 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
10207 else
10209 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
10210 dw_die_ref copy = clone_tree (targ);
10212 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
10213 type unit. */
10214 mark_dies (copy);
10216 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
10217 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
10218 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
10219 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
10220 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10221 entry->orig = targ;
10222 entry->copy = copy;
10223 *slot = entry;
10225 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
10226 into the new type unit. */
10227 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
10228 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10229 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10230 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
10231 decl_table);
10233 add_child_die (parent, copy);
10234 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
10236 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
10237 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
10238 get visited otherwise. */
10239 if (parent != unit)
10241 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
10242 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
10243 parent->die_mark = 1;
10244 while (parent->die_parent
10245 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
10247 parent = parent->die_parent;
10248 parent->die_mark = 1;
10250 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
10256 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
10259 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
10260 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
10261 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
10262 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
10263 don't have an external reference. */
10265 static void
10266 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
10268 htab_t decl_table;
10270 mark_dies (unit);
10271 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
10272 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
10273 htab_delete (decl_table);
10274 unmark_dies (unit);
10277 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
10278 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
10279 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
10281 static void
10282 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
10284 dw_die_ref c;
10286 if (! die->die_child)
10287 return;
10289 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
10290 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
10292 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
10295 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
10297 static void
10298 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
10300 dw_die_ref c;
10301 dw_attr_ref a;
10302 unsigned ix;
10304 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10305 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
10306 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
10308 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
10311 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
10312 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
10313 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
10314 die are visited recursively. */
10316 static void
10317 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
10319 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10320 unsigned int n_alloc;
10321 dw_die_ref c;
10322 dw_attr_ref a;
10323 unsigned ix;
10325 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
10326 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
10327 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10328 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
10329 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
10331 gcc_assert (dwarf_version >= 4 || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
10332 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
10335 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10337 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10338 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
10339 unsigned ix;
10340 bool ok = true;
10342 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
10343 continue;
10344 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
10345 continue;
10347 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
10348 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
10349 continue;
10351 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
10353 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
10354 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
10355 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
10357 ok = false;
10358 break;
10361 if (ok)
10362 break;
10365 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
10367 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
10369 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10370 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
10371 n_alloc);
10373 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
10374 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
10375 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
10378 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
10379 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
10382 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
10383 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
10386 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
10388 static int
10389 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
10391 int log;
10393 if (value == 0)
10394 log = 0;
10395 else
10396 log = floor_log2 (value);
10398 log = log / 8;
10399 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
10401 return log;
10404 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
10405 .debug_info section. */
10407 static unsigned long
10408 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
10410 unsigned long size = 0;
10411 dw_attr_ref a;
10412 unsigned ix;
10414 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
10415 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10417 switch (AT_class (a))
10419 case dw_val_class_addr:
10420 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10421 break;
10422 case dw_val_class_offset:
10423 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10424 break;
10425 case dw_val_class_loc:
10427 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10429 /* Block length. */
10430 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10431 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
10432 else
10433 size += constant_size (lsize);
10434 size += lsize;
10436 break;
10437 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10438 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10439 break;
10440 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10441 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10442 break;
10443 case dw_val_class_const:
10444 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
10445 break;
10446 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10447 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10448 break;
10449 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10450 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10451 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10452 size++; /* block */
10453 break;
10454 case dw_val_class_vec:
10455 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10456 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
10457 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10458 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
10459 break;
10460 case dw_val_class_flag:
10461 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10462 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10463 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10464 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10465 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10466 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10467 the same abbrev entry. */
10468 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
10469 else
10470 size += 1;
10471 break;
10472 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10473 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10475 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_sig8; for earlier versions
10476 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
10477 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
10478 it's always sized as an offset. */
10479 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10480 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
10481 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
10482 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10483 else
10484 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10486 else
10487 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10488 break;
10489 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10490 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10491 break;
10492 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10493 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10494 break;
10495 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10496 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10497 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10498 break;
10499 case dw_val_class_str:
10500 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
10501 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10502 else
10503 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
10504 break;
10505 case dw_val_class_file:
10506 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
10507 break;
10508 case dw_val_class_data8:
10509 size += 8;
10510 break;
10511 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10512 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10513 break;
10514 default:
10515 gcc_unreachable ();
10519 return size;
10522 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
10523 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
10524 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
10525 die_offset field in each DIE. */
10527 static void
10528 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
10530 dw_die_ref c;
10532 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
10533 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
10535 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
10537 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10538 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
10539 next_die_offset += 1;
10542 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
10543 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
10544 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
10545 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
10547 static void
10548 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10550 dw_die_ref c;
10552 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
10554 die->die_mark = 1;
10555 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
10558 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
10560 static void
10561 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10563 dw_die_ref c;
10565 if (dwarf_version < 4)
10566 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10568 die->die_mark = 0;
10569 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
10572 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
10574 static void
10575 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10577 dw_die_ref c;
10578 dw_attr_ref a;
10579 unsigned ix;
10581 if (!die->die_mark)
10582 return;
10583 die->die_mark = 0;
10585 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
10587 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10588 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10589 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
10592 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
10593 generated for the compilation unit. */
10595 static unsigned long
10596 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10598 unsigned long size;
10599 unsigned i;
10600 pubname_ref p;
10602 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
10603 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, p)
10604 if (names != pubtype_table
10605 || p->die->die_offset != 0
10606 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10607 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
10609 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10610 return size;
10613 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
10615 static unsigned long
10616 size_of_aranges (void)
10618 unsigned long size;
10620 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
10622 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
10623 if (text_section_used)
10624 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10625 if (cold_text_section_used)
10626 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10627 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
10629 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
10630 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10631 return size;
10634 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
10636 static enum dwarf_form
10637 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10639 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
10641 case dw_val_class_addr:
10642 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
10643 switch (a->dw_attr)
10645 case DW_AT_low_pc:
10646 case DW_AT_high_pc:
10647 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
10648 case DW_AT_trampoline:
10649 return DW_FORM_addr;
10650 default:
10651 break;
10653 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10655 case 1:
10656 return DW_FORM_data1;
10657 case 2:
10658 return DW_FORM_data2;
10659 case 4:
10660 return DW_FORM_data4;
10661 case 8:
10662 return DW_FORM_data8;
10663 default:
10664 gcc_unreachable ();
10666 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10667 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10668 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10669 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
10670 /* FALLTHRU */
10671 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10672 case dw_val_class_offset:
10673 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
10675 case 4:
10676 return DW_FORM_data4;
10677 case 8:
10678 return DW_FORM_data8;
10679 default:
10680 gcc_unreachable ();
10682 case dw_val_class_loc:
10683 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10684 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
10685 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
10687 case 1:
10688 return DW_FORM_block1;
10689 case 2:
10690 return DW_FORM_block2;
10691 default:
10692 gcc_unreachable ();
10694 case dw_val_class_const:
10695 return DW_FORM_sdata;
10696 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10697 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
10699 case 1:
10700 return DW_FORM_data1;
10701 case 2:
10702 return DW_FORM_data2;
10703 case 4:
10704 return DW_FORM_data4;
10705 case 8:
10706 return DW_FORM_data8;
10707 default:
10708 gcc_unreachable ();
10710 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10711 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10713 case 8:
10714 return DW_FORM_data2;
10715 case 16:
10716 return DW_FORM_data4;
10717 case 32:
10718 return DW_FORM_data8;
10719 case 64:
10720 default:
10721 return DW_FORM_block1;
10723 case dw_val_class_vec:
10724 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10725 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
10727 case 1:
10728 return DW_FORM_block1;
10729 case 2:
10730 return DW_FORM_block2;
10731 case 4:
10732 return DW_FORM_block4;
10733 default:
10734 gcc_unreachable ();
10736 case dw_val_class_flag:
10737 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10739 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10740 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10741 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10742 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10743 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10744 the same abbrev entry. */
10745 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
10746 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
10748 return DW_FORM_flag;
10749 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10750 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10751 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
10752 else
10753 return DW_FORM_ref;
10754 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10755 return DW_FORM_data;
10756 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10757 return DW_FORM_addr;
10758 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10759 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10760 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
10761 case dw_val_class_str:
10762 return AT_string_form (a);
10763 case dw_val_class_file:
10764 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
10766 case 1:
10767 return DW_FORM_data1;
10768 case 2:
10769 return DW_FORM_data2;
10770 case 4:
10771 return DW_FORM_data4;
10772 default:
10773 gcc_unreachable ();
10776 case dw_val_class_data8:
10777 return DW_FORM_data8;
10779 default:
10780 gcc_unreachable ();
10784 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
10786 static void
10787 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10789 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
10791 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
10794 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
10795 table. */
10797 static void
10798 output_abbrev_section (void)
10800 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10802 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10804 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10805 unsigned ix;
10806 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
10808 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
10809 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
10810 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
10812 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
10813 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
10814 else
10815 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
10817 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
10818 ix++)
10820 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
10821 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
10822 output_value_format (a_attr);
10825 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10826 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10829 /* Terminate the table. */
10830 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10833 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
10835 static inline void
10836 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
10838 char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10840 if (sym == 0)
10841 return;
10843 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
10844 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
10845 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
10846 will break. */
10847 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
10849 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
10852 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10853 expression. */
10855 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10856 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
10857 const char *section)
10859 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_list_node ();
10861 retlist->begin = begin;
10862 retlist->end = end;
10863 retlist->expr = expr;
10864 retlist->section = section;
10866 return retlist;
10869 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
10870 hasn't got one yet. */
10872 static inline void
10873 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10875 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
10876 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10879 /* Output the location list given to us. */
10881 static void
10882 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10884 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
10886 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10888 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
10889 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10891 unsigned long size;
10892 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
10893 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
10894 continue;
10895 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10897 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10898 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10899 list_head->ll_symbol);
10900 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10901 "Location list end address (%s)",
10902 list_head->ll_symbol);
10904 else
10906 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10907 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10908 list_head->ll_symbol);
10909 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10910 "Location list end address (%s)",
10911 list_head->ll_symbol);
10913 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10915 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10916 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10917 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
10919 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
10922 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10923 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10924 list_head->ll_symbol);
10925 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10926 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10927 list_head->ll_symbol);
10930 /* Output a type signature. */
10932 static inline void
10933 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10935 int i;
10937 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10938 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10941 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
10942 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10944 static void
10945 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10947 dw_attr_ref a;
10948 dw_die_ref c;
10949 unsigned long size;
10950 unsigned ix;
10952 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
10953 them to point to. */
10954 if (dwarf_version < 4 && die->die_id.die_symbol)
10955 output_die_symbol (die);
10957 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
10958 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10959 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10961 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10963 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10965 switch (AT_class (a))
10967 case dw_val_class_addr:
10968 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10969 break;
10971 case dw_val_class_offset:
10972 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10973 "%s", name);
10974 break;
10976 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10978 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10980 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10981 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
10982 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10983 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10984 *p = '\0';
10986 break;
10988 case dw_val_class_loc:
10989 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10991 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10992 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10993 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10994 else
10995 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10997 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
10998 break;
11000 case dw_val_class_const:
11001 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
11002 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
11003 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
11004 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
11005 break;
11007 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
11008 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
11009 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
11010 break;
11012 case dw_val_class_const_double:
11014 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
11016 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
11017 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
11018 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11019 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11020 NULL);
11022 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
11024 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
11025 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
11027 else
11029 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
11030 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
11033 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11034 first, name);
11035 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11036 second, NULL);
11038 break;
11040 case dw_val_class_vec:
11042 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
11043 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
11044 unsigned int i;
11045 unsigned char *p;
11047 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
11048 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
11049 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
11051 elt_size /= 2;
11052 len *= 2;
11054 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
11055 i < len;
11056 i++, p += elt_size)
11057 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
11058 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
11059 break;
11062 case dw_val_class_flag:
11063 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11065 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
11066 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
11067 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
11068 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
11069 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
11070 the same abbrev entry. */
11071 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
11072 if (flag_debug_asm)
11073 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
11074 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
11075 break;
11077 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
11078 break;
11080 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
11082 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
11084 gcc_assert (sym);
11085 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
11086 "%s", name);
11088 break;
11090 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
11091 if (AT_ref_external (a))
11093 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11095 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
11096 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
11098 gcc_assert (type_node);
11099 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
11101 else
11103 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
11104 int size;
11106 gcc_assert (sym);
11107 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
11108 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
11109 offset. */
11110 if (dwarf_version == 2)
11111 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11112 else
11113 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
11114 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
11115 name);
11118 else
11120 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
11121 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
11122 "%s", name);
11124 break;
11126 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
11128 char l1[20];
11130 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
11131 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
11132 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
11133 "%s", name);
11135 break;
11137 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
11138 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11139 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
11140 "%s", name);
11141 break;
11143 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
11144 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
11145 break;
11147 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
11148 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11149 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
11150 break;
11152 case dw_val_class_macptr:
11153 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11154 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
11155 break;
11157 case dw_val_class_str:
11158 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
11159 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11160 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
11161 debug_str_section,
11162 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
11163 else
11164 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
11165 break;
11167 case dw_val_class_file:
11169 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
11171 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
11172 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
11173 break;
11176 case dw_val_class_data8:
11178 int i;
11180 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11181 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
11182 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
11183 break;
11186 default:
11187 gcc_unreachable ();
11191 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
11193 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
11194 if (die->die_child != NULL)
11195 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
11196 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
11199 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
11200 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
11202 static void
11203 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
11205 int ver = dwarf_version;
11207 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11208 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11209 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11210 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11211 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
11212 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
11213 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
11214 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
11215 debug_abbrev_section,
11216 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11217 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11220 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
11222 static void
11223 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
11225 const char *secname;
11226 char *oldsym, *tmp;
11228 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
11229 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
11230 return;
11232 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
11233 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
11234 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
11235 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
11236 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11237 mark_dies (die);
11239 build_abbrev_table (die);
11241 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11242 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11243 calc_die_sizes (die);
11245 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11246 if (oldsym)
11248 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
11250 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
11251 secname = tmp;
11252 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
11253 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11255 else
11256 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
11258 /* Output debugging information. */
11259 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11260 output_die (die);
11262 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
11263 output_pubnames. */
11264 if (oldsym)
11266 unmark_dies (die);
11267 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
11271 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
11273 static void
11274 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
11276 const char *secname;
11277 char *tmp;
11278 int i;
11279 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11280 tree comdat_key;
11281 #endif
11283 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11284 mark_dies (node->root_die);
11286 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die);
11288 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11289 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11290 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
11292 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11293 secname = ".debug_types";
11294 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11295 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
11296 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11297 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11298 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
11299 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
11300 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
11301 comdat_key);
11302 #else
11303 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11304 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
11305 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11306 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11307 secname = tmp;
11308 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11309 #endif
11311 /* Output debugging information. */
11312 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11313 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
11314 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
11315 "Offset to Type DIE");
11316 output_die (node->root_die);
11318 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
11321 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
11323 static const char *
11324 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
11326 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
11327 return NULL;
11328 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
11331 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
11333 static void
11334 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
11336 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11338 pubname_entry e;
11340 e.die = die;
11341 e.name = xstrdup (str);
11342 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
11346 static void
11347 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11349 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections && TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11351 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11352 if (name)
11353 add_pubname_string (name, die);
11357 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
11359 static void
11360 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11362 pubname_entry e;
11364 if (!targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11365 return;
11367 e.name = NULL;
11368 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11369 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent))
11370 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
11372 e.die = die;
11373 if (TYPE_P (decl))
11375 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
11377 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11378 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
11379 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
11380 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
11381 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
11382 else
11383 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
11386 else
11388 e.name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11389 if (e.name)
11390 e.name = xstrdup (e.name);
11393 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
11394 it to the table. */
11395 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
11396 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
11400 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
11401 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
11403 static void
11404 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
11406 unsigned i;
11407 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
11408 pubname_ref pub;
11410 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11411 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11412 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11413 if (names == pubname_table)
11414 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11415 "Length of Public Names Info");
11416 else
11417 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11418 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
11419 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11420 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11421 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11422 debug_info_section,
11423 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11424 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
11425 "Compilation Unit Length");
11427 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, pub)
11429 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11430 if (names == pubname_table)
11431 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
11433 if (names != pubtype_table
11434 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
11435 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
11437 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
11438 "DIE offset");
11440 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
11444 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11447 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
11449 static void
11450 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11452 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
11453 return;
11455 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
11457 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11458 arange_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, arange_table,
11459 arange_table_allocated);
11460 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
11461 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
11464 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
11467 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
11468 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
11469 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
11471 static void
11472 output_aranges (void)
11474 unsigned i;
11475 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
11477 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11478 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11479 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11480 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
11481 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
11482 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11483 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11484 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11485 debug_info_section,
11486 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11487 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
11488 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
11490 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
11491 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
11493 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
11494 pointer size. */
11495 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
11496 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11497 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
11498 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
11501 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
11502 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
11503 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
11504 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
11505 confused with the terminator. */
11506 if (text_section_used)
11508 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
11509 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
11510 text_section_label, "Length");
11512 if (cold_text_section_used)
11514 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
11515 "Address");
11516 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
11517 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
11520 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
11522 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
11524 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11525 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
11527 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11529 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
11530 "Address");
11531 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
11532 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
11534 else
11536 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
11537 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
11538 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
11539 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
11540 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11542 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
11544 loc = AT_loc (a);
11545 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
11547 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11548 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
11549 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11550 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
11551 "Length");
11555 /* Output the terminator words. */
11556 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11557 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11560 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
11561 was placed. */
11563 static unsigned int
11564 add_ranges_num (int num)
11566 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
11568 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
11570 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11571 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
11572 ranges_table_allocated);
11573 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
11574 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
11577 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
11578 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
11580 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11583 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11584 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
11586 static unsigned int
11587 add_ranges (const_tree block)
11589 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
11592 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
11593 labels. */
11595 static void
11596 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11597 bool *added)
11599 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
11600 unsigned int offset;
11602 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
11604 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11605 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
11606 ranges_by_label,
11607 ranges_by_label_allocated);
11608 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
11609 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
11610 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
11613 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
11614 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
11615 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
11617 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
11618 if (!*added)
11620 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset);
11621 *added = true;
11625 static void
11626 output_ranges (void)
11628 unsigned i;
11629 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11630 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11632 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
11634 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
11636 if (block_num > 0)
11638 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11639 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11641 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11642 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11644 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11645 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11646 base of the text section. */
11647 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11649 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11650 text_section_label,
11651 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11652 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11653 text_section_label, NULL);
11656 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11657 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11658 about whether the target supports cross-section
11659 arithmetic. */
11660 else
11662 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11663 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11664 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11667 fmt = NULL;
11670 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11671 else if (block_num < 0)
11673 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11675 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11677 gcc_unreachable ();
11678 #if 0
11679 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11680 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11681 the #if 0 above. */
11682 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11683 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11684 text_section_label,
11685 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11686 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11687 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11688 text_section_label, NULL);
11689 #endif
11691 else
11693 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11694 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11695 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11696 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11697 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11698 NULL);
11701 else
11703 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11704 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11705 fmt = start_fmt;
11710 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11711 struct file_info
11713 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11714 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11715 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11716 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11717 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11720 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11721 files. */
11722 struct dir_info
11724 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11725 int length; /* Path length. */
11726 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11727 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11728 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11731 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11732 the directories in the path. */
11734 static int
11735 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11737 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11738 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11739 const unsigned char *cp1;
11740 const unsigned char *cp2;
11742 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11743 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11744 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11745 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11746 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11747 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11748 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11750 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11751 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11753 while (1)
11755 ++cp1;
11756 ++cp2;
11757 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11758 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11759 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11760 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11761 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11763 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11764 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11765 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11769 struct file_name_acquire_data
11771 struct file_info *files;
11772 int used_files;
11773 int max_files;
11776 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11778 static int
11779 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
11781 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
11782 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
11783 struct file_info *fi;
11784 const char *f;
11786 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11788 if (! d->emitted_number)
11789 return 1;
11791 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11793 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11795 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11796 f = d->filename;
11797 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11798 f += 2;
11800 /* Create a new array entry. */
11801 fi->path = f;
11802 fi->length = strlen (f);
11803 fi->file_idx = d;
11805 /* Search for the file name part. */
11806 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11807 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11809 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11811 if (g != NULL)
11813 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11814 f = g;
11817 #endif
11819 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11820 return 1;
11823 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11824 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11825 slowdowns with many input files. */
11827 static void
11828 output_file_names (void)
11830 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11831 int numfiles;
11832 struct file_info *files;
11833 struct dir_info *dirs;
11834 int *saved;
11835 int *savehere;
11836 int *backmap;
11837 int ndirs;
11838 int idx_offset;
11839 int i;
11841 if (!last_emitted_file)
11843 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11844 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11845 return;
11848 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11850 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11851 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11852 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11854 fnad.files = files;
11855 fnad.used_files = 0;
11856 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11857 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
11858 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11860 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11862 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11863 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11864 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11865 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11866 dirs[0].count = 1;
11867 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11868 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11869 ndirs = 1;
11871 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11872 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11873 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11874 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11876 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11877 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11878 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11880 else
11882 int j;
11884 /* This is a new directory. */
11885 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11886 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11887 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11888 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11889 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11891 /* Search for a prefix. */
11892 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11893 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11894 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11895 && dirs[j].length > 1
11896 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11897 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11898 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11899 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11901 ++ndirs;
11904 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11905 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11906 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11907 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11908 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11909 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11910 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11911 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11913 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11914 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11916 int j;
11917 int total;
11919 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11920 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11921 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11922 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11924 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11926 savehere[j] = 0;
11927 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11929 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11930 dirs[j] path. */
11931 int k;
11933 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11934 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11935 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11937 if (k == (int) i)
11939 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11940 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11941 dirs[i]. */
11942 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11943 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11948 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11949 directory. */
11950 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11952 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11953 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11954 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11956 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11957 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11959 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11960 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11965 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11966 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11967 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11968 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11969 dirs[i].length
11970 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11971 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11973 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11975 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11976 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11977 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11978 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11979 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11980 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11982 /* Now write all the file names. */
11983 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11985 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11986 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11988 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11989 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11991 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11992 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11994 int ver;
11995 long long cdt;
11996 long siz;
11997 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11998 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11999 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
12000 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
12002 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
12003 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
12004 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
12006 dw2_asm_output_nstring
12007 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
12009 /* Include directory index. */
12010 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12012 /* Modification time. */
12013 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
12014 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
12015 ? cdt : 0,
12016 NULL);
12018 /* File length in bytes. */
12019 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
12020 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
12021 ? siz : 0,
12022 NULL);
12023 #else
12024 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
12025 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
12027 /* Include directory index. */
12028 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12030 /* Modification time. */
12031 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12033 /* File length in bytes. */
12034 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12035 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12038 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12042 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
12043 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
12045 static void
12046 output_line_info (void)
12048 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
12049 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12050 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12051 unsigned opc;
12052 unsigned n_op_args;
12053 unsigned long lt_index;
12054 unsigned long current_line;
12055 long line_offset;
12056 long line_delta;
12057 unsigned long current_file;
12058 unsigned long function;
12059 int ver = dwarf_version;
12061 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
12062 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
12063 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
12064 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
12066 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12067 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12068 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12069 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
12070 "Length of Source Line Info");
12071 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
12073 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
12074 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
12075 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
12077 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
12078 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
12079 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
12080 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
12081 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
12082 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
12083 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
12084 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
12085 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
12086 "Minimum Instruction Length");
12088 if (ver >= 4)
12089 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12090 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12091 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12092 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12093 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12094 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12095 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12096 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12097 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12098 "Special Opcode Base");
12100 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12102 switch (opc)
12104 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12105 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12106 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12107 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12108 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12109 n_op_args = 1;
12110 break;
12111 default:
12112 n_op_args = 0;
12113 break;
12116 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12117 opc, n_op_args);
12120 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12121 output_file_names ();
12122 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12124 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
12125 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
12126 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
12128 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
12129 a series of state machine operations. */
12130 current_file = 1;
12131 current_line = 1;
12133 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
12134 strcpy (prev_line_label, crtl->subsections.cold_section_label);
12135 else
12136 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
12137 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
12139 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
12141 #if 0
12142 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
12143 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
12144 prologue. */
12146 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
12147 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
12148 that anything after the last address is this line. */
12149 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
12150 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
12151 continue;
12152 #endif
12154 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
12156 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
12157 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
12158 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
12159 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
12160 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
12161 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
12163 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
12164 if (0)
12166 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
12167 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12168 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12169 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12171 else
12173 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
12174 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
12175 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12176 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12177 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12178 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12181 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
12183 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
12184 different from the previous line. */
12185 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
12187 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
12188 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
12189 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
12192 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
12193 that uses the least amount of space. */
12194 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
12196 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
12197 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12198 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
12199 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12200 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
12201 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
12202 takes 1 byte. */
12203 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12204 "line %lu", current_line);
12205 else
12207 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
12208 depending on the value being encoded. */
12209 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12210 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
12211 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12212 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12215 else
12216 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
12217 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12220 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
12221 if (0)
12223 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12224 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12225 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12227 else
12229 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12230 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12231 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12232 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
12235 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
12236 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12237 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12239 function = 0;
12240 current_file = 1;
12241 current_line = 1;
12242 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
12244 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
12245 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
12247 #if 0
12248 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
12249 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
12250 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
12251 && line_info->function == function)
12252 goto cont;
12253 #endif
12255 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
12256 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
12257 to handle it differently. */
12258 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
12259 lt_index);
12260 if (function != line_info->function)
12262 function = line_info->function;
12264 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
12265 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12266 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12267 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12268 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12270 else
12272 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
12273 if (0)
12275 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12276 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12277 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12279 else
12281 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12282 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12283 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12284 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12288 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
12290 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
12291 different from the previous line. */
12292 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
12294 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
12295 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
12296 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
12299 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
12300 that uses the least amount of space. */
12301 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
12303 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
12304 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12305 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
12306 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12307 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12308 "line %lu", current_line);
12309 else
12311 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12312 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
12313 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12317 else
12318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12320 #if 0
12321 cont:
12322 #endif
12324 lt_index++;
12326 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
12327 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
12328 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
12330 current_file = 1;
12331 current_line = 1;
12333 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
12334 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
12335 if (0)
12337 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12338 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12339 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12341 else
12343 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12344 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12345 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12346 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12349 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
12350 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
12351 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12352 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12356 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12357 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12360 /* Return the size of the .debug_dcall table for the compilation unit. */
12362 static unsigned long
12363 size_of_dcall_table (void)
12365 unsigned long size;
12366 unsigned int i;
12367 dcall_entry *p;
12368 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
12370 /* Header: version + debug info section pointer + pointer size. */
12371 size = 2 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
12373 /* Each entry: code label + DIE offset. */
12374 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p)
12376 gcc_assert (p->targ_die != NULL);
12377 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
12378 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
12380 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
12381 gcc_assert (poc_die);
12382 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
12383 if (poc_die)
12384 size += (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
12385 + size_of_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset));
12387 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset);
12390 return size;
12393 /* Output the direct call table used to disambiguate PC values when
12394 identical function have been merged. */
12396 static void
12397 output_dcall_table (void)
12399 unsigned i;
12400 unsigned long dcall_length = size_of_dcall_table ();
12401 dcall_entry *p;
12402 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12403 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
12405 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12406 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12407 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12408 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, dcall_length,
12409 "Length of Direct Call Table");
12410 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
12411 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
12412 debug_info_section,
12413 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
12414 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
12416 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p)
12418 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
12419 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
12421 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
12422 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
12423 if (poc_die)
12425 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, "New caller");
12426 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset,
12427 "Caller DIE offset");
12430 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
12431 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
12432 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset,
12433 "Callee DIE offset");
12437 /* Return the size of the .debug_vcall table for the compilation unit. */
12439 static unsigned long
12440 size_of_vcall_table (void)
12442 unsigned long size;
12443 unsigned int i;
12444 vcall_entry *p;
12446 /* Header: version + pointer size. */
12447 size = 2 + 1;
12449 /* Each entry: code label + vtable slot index. */
12450 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p)
12451 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot);
12453 return size;
12456 /* Output the virtual call table used to disambiguate PC values when
12457 identical function have been merged. */
12459 static void
12460 output_vcall_table (void)
12462 unsigned i;
12463 unsigned long vcall_length = size_of_vcall_table ();
12464 vcall_entry *p;
12465 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12467 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12468 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12469 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12470 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, vcall_length,
12471 "Length of Virtual Call Table");
12472 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
12473 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
12475 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p)
12477 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
12478 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
12479 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot, "Vtable slot");
12483 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12484 a DIE that describes the given type.
12486 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12487 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12489 static dw_die_ref
12490 base_type_die (tree type)
12492 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12493 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12495 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
12496 return 0;
12498 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12499 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12500 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12501 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12503 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12505 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12506 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12507 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12508 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12509 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12510 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12512 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12513 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12514 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12516 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12517 break;
12520 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12522 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12523 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12524 else
12525 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12527 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12528 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12529 else
12530 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12531 break;
12533 case REAL_TYPE:
12534 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12536 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12537 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12538 else
12539 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12541 else
12542 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12543 break;
12545 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12546 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12547 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12548 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12549 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12550 else
12551 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12552 break;
12554 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12555 a user defined type for it. */
12556 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12557 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12558 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12559 else
12560 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12561 break;
12563 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12564 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12565 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12566 break;
12568 default:
12569 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12570 gcc_unreachable ();
12573 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12575 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12576 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12577 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12579 return base_type_result;
12582 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12583 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12585 static inline int
12586 is_base_type (tree type)
12588 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12590 case ERROR_MARK:
12591 case VOID_TYPE:
12592 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12593 case REAL_TYPE:
12594 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12595 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12596 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12597 return 1;
12599 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12600 case RECORD_TYPE:
12601 case UNION_TYPE:
12602 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12603 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12604 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12605 case METHOD_TYPE:
12606 case POINTER_TYPE:
12607 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12608 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12609 case LANG_TYPE:
12610 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12611 return 0;
12613 default:
12614 gcc_unreachable ();
12617 return 0;
12620 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12621 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12622 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12623 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12624 ERROR_MARK node. */
12626 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12627 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12629 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12630 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12631 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12632 return 0;
12633 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
12634 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
12635 else
12636 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12639 /* Similarly, but return a double_int instead of UHWI. */
12641 static inline double_int
12642 double_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12644 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12645 return uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_WORD);
12646 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12647 return double_int_zero;
12648 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12649 return tree_to_double_int (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12650 else
12651 return uhwi_to_double_int (TYPE_ALIGN (type));
12654 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12655 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12657 static dw_die_ref
12658 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
12660 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12661 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12663 if (context_die == NULL)
12664 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12666 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12668 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12670 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12671 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12672 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12675 if (low)
12676 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
12677 if (high)
12678 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
12680 return subrange_die;
12683 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12684 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
12686 static dw_die_ref
12687 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
12688 dw_die_ref context_die)
12690 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12691 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12692 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12693 tree item_type = NULL;
12694 tree qualified_type;
12695 tree name, low, high;
12697 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12698 return NULL;
12700 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12701 this type. */
12702 qualified_type
12703 = get_qualified_type (type,
12704 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
12705 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
12707 if (qualified_type == sizetype
12708 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12709 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12711 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
12712 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12713 == INTEGER_TYPE
12714 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12715 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
12716 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12717 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
12718 #endif
12719 qualified_type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12722 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12723 if (qualified_type)
12725 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12726 if (mod_type_die)
12727 return mod_type_die;
12730 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12732 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12733 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12734 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12736 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12738 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12740 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12741 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12742 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12744 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12745 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12746 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12747 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12748 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12749 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
12750 type to which it refers. */
12751 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
12752 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
12753 context_die);
12754 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12757 if (is_const_type)
12759 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12760 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
12762 else if (is_volatile_type)
12764 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12765 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
12767 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
12769 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12770 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12771 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12772 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12773 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12774 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12775 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12777 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12779 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
12780 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, comp_unit_die (),
12781 type);
12782 else
12783 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12784 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12785 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12786 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12787 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12788 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12789 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12791 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12792 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12793 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12795 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
12796 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12798 else if (is_base_type (type))
12799 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
12800 else
12802 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12804 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12805 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12806 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12807 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12808 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12809 ..._TYPE node. */
12810 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12811 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12812 else
12813 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12814 not the main variant. */
12815 return lookup_type_die (type);
12818 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12819 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12820 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12821 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12822 if the base type already has the same name. */
12823 if (name
12824 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12825 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12826 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
12827 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12828 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12829 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12831 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12832 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12833 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12834 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12835 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12836 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12838 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
12839 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
12840 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, "__unknown__");
12842 if (qualified_type)
12843 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12845 if (item_type)
12846 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12847 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12848 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12849 types are possible in Ada. */
12850 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12851 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
12852 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
12853 context_die);
12855 if (sub_die != NULL)
12856 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12858 return mod_type_die;
12861 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12862 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12863 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12865 static void
12866 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12868 tree parms, args;
12869 int parms_num, i;
12870 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12872 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12873 return;
12875 if (TYPE_P (t))
12876 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12877 else if (DECL_P (t))
12878 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12880 gcc_assert (die);
12882 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12883 if (!parms)
12884 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12885 or function. End of story. */
12886 return;
12888 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12889 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12890 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12892 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12894 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12895 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12896 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12897 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12899 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12901 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12902 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12903 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12904 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12905 an argument pack. */
12906 if (arg_pack_elems)
12907 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12908 arg_pack_elems,
12909 die);
12910 else
12911 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12912 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
12917 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12918 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12919 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12920 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12921 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12922 name of the PARM.
12923 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12924 as a child node. */
12926 static dw_die_ref
12927 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12928 bool emit_name_p,
12929 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12931 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12932 const char *name = NULL;
12934 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12935 return NULL;
12937 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12938 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12939 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12940 and arguments. */
12941 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12942 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12943 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12944 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12945 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12946 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12947 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12948 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12949 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12950 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12951 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12952 name of the template template argument. */
12953 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12954 parent_die, parm);
12955 else
12956 gcc_unreachable ();
12958 if (tmpl_die)
12960 tree tmpl_type;
12962 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12963 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12964 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12965 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12966 the die. */
12967 if (emit_name_p)
12969 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12970 gcc_assert (name);
12971 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12974 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12976 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12977 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12978 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12979 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12980 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12981 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12982 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
12983 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
12984 parent_die);
12986 else
12988 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12989 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12990 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12992 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12993 to the name of the argument. */
12994 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12995 if (name)
12996 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12999 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13000 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
13001 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
13002 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
13003 of ARG.
13004 We must be careful here:
13005 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
13006 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
13007 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
13008 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
13009 emitted after cgraph computations.
13010 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
13011 after cgraph is ready. */
13012 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
13015 return tmpl_die;
13018 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13019 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13020 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
13022 static dw_die_ref
13023 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13024 tree parm_pack_args,
13025 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13027 dw_die_ref die;
13028 int j;
13030 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13032 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13033 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13034 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13035 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13036 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13037 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13038 die);
13039 return die;
13042 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13043 an enumerated type. */
13045 static inline int
13046 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13048 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13051 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13053 static unsigned int
13054 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13056 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13058 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13060 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13061 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
13063 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13064 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13065 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13067 #endif
13069 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13072 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13073 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13074 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13076 static void
13077 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13079 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13081 if (*list_head != NULL)
13083 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13084 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13087 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13088 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13092 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13093 zero if there is none. */
13095 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13096 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13098 rtx regs;
13100 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13101 return 0;
13103 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13104 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13105 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13106 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13107 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13108 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13109 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13111 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13113 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13115 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
13116 if (result)
13117 add_loc_descr (&result,
13118 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13120 return result;
13123 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13125 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
13126 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13127 else
13128 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
13131 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13132 a given hard register number. */
13134 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13135 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13137 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13139 if (regno <= 31)
13140 reg_loc_descr
13141 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13142 else
13143 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13145 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13146 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13148 return reg_loc_descr;
13151 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13152 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13154 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13155 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13156 enum var_init_status initialized)
13158 int nregs, size, i;
13159 unsigned reg;
13160 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13162 reg = REGNO (rtl);
13163 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13164 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
13166 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13167 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13168 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13170 #endif
13171 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13172 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
13174 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13175 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13177 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13179 loc_result = NULL;
13180 while (nregs--)
13182 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13184 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13185 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13186 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13187 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13188 ++reg;
13190 return loc_result;
13193 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13195 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13197 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13198 loc_result = NULL;
13200 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13202 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13204 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13205 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13206 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13207 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13208 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13211 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13212 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13213 return loc_result;
13216 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
13218 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13219 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13221 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13223 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13224 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13225 if (i >= 0)
13227 if (i <= 31)
13228 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13229 else if (i <= 0xff)
13230 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13231 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13232 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13233 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13234 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13235 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13236 else
13237 op = DW_OP_constu;
13239 else
13241 if (i >= -0x80)
13242 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13243 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13244 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13245 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13246 || i >= -0x80000000)
13247 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13248 else
13249 op = DW_OP_consts;
13252 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13255 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13256 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13258 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13259 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13261 int litsize;
13262 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13264 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13265 return NULL;
13267 if (i >= 0)
13269 if (i <= 31)
13270 litsize = 1;
13271 else if (i <= 0xff)
13272 litsize = 2;
13273 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13274 litsize = 3;
13275 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13276 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13277 litsize = 5;
13278 else
13279 litsize = 1 + size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13281 else
13283 if (i >= -0x80)
13284 litsize = 2;
13285 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13286 litsize = 3;
13287 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13288 || i >= -0x80000000)
13289 litsize = 5;
13290 else
13291 litsize = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13293 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13294 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13295 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13296 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13297 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13298 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13300 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13301 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13302 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13303 return loc_result;
13306 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13307 size, 0);
13308 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13309 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13310 return loc_result;
13313 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13315 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13316 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
13317 enum var_init_status initialized)
13319 unsigned int regno;
13320 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13321 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
13323 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13324 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13325 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13326 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13327 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13329 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
13331 if (elim != reg)
13333 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
13335 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
13336 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
13338 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13339 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13340 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13341 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13342 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13343 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13345 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13346 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13347 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13348 access stack variables. */
13349 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13350 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13352 int base_reg
13353 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13354 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13355 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
13356 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13359 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13360 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13363 else if (!optimize
13364 && fde
13365 && (fde->drap_reg == REGNO (reg)
13366 || fde->vdrap_reg == REGNO (reg)))
13368 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13369 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13370 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13371 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13372 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13373 else in other part of the routine. */
13374 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13377 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
13378 if (regno <= 31)
13379 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
13380 offset, 0);
13381 else
13382 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
13384 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13385 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13387 return result;
13390 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13392 static inline int
13393 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13395 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13396 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13397 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13398 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13401 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13402 failed. */
13404 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13405 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13407 tree base;
13408 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13410 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || MEM_OFFSET (mem) == NULL_RTX)
13411 return NULL;
13413 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13414 if (base == NULL
13415 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
13416 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13417 return NULL;
13419 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
13420 if (loc_result == NULL)
13421 return NULL;
13423 if (INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)))
13424 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)));
13426 return loc_result;
13429 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13430 expression. */
13432 static void
13433 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13435 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13437 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13438 if (expr)
13439 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13440 if (rtl)
13442 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13443 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13445 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13449 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
13450 or via for_each_rtx. */
13452 static int
13453 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13455 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
13457 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
13459 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
13460 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13461 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13462 inform (current_function_decl
13463 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13464 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13465 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13466 XINT (rtl, 1));
13467 #endif
13468 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13469 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13470 return 1;
13473 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
13474 return 0;
13476 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13478 bool marked;
13479 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13480 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13481 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13482 if (!marked)
13484 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13485 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13486 return 1;
13490 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13491 return 1;
13493 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13494 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13495 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13496 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13497 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13498 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13500 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13502 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13504 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13505 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13506 return 1;
13510 return 0;
13513 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13514 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13515 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13517 static bool
13518 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13520 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13521 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
13523 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13524 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
13526 return true;
13529 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
13530 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
13531 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
13532 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
13534 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
13535 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
13536 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
13537 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
13539 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
13540 autoincrement addressing modes.
13542 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
13543 location list for RTL.
13545 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
13547 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13548 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
13549 enum var_init_status initialized)
13551 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
13552 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13553 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13555 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
13556 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
13557 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
13558 zeroth element of the array. */
13560 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
13562 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13564 case POST_INC:
13565 case POST_DEC:
13566 case POST_MODIFY:
13567 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13569 case SUBREG:
13570 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13571 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13572 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13573 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13574 contains the given subreg. */
13575 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
13576 break;
13577 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
13578 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13579 break;
13580 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (rtl)) != MODE_INT)
13581 break;
13582 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, initialized);
13583 break;
13585 case REG:
13586 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
13587 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
13588 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
13589 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
13590 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
13591 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
13592 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
13593 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
13594 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
13595 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
13596 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
13597 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
13598 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
13599 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13600 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13601 else if (stack_realign_drap
13602 && crtl->drap_reg
13603 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
13604 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13606 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
13607 out, use DRAP instead. */
13608 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
13609 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13611 break;
13613 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13614 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13615 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13616 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13617 if (op0 == 0)
13618 break;
13619 else
13621 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13622 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13623 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13624 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
13625 op = DW_OP_shra;
13626 else
13627 op = DW_OP_shr;
13628 mem_loc_result = op0;
13629 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13630 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13631 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13632 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13634 break;
13636 case MEM:
13637 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
13638 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13639 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13640 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13641 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
13643 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13645 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl, "DWARF address size mismatch");
13646 return 0;
13648 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13649 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
13650 else
13651 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13652 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
13653 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)), 0));
13655 else
13657 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
13658 if (new_rtl != rtl)
13659 return mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
13661 break;
13663 case LO_SUM:
13664 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13666 /* ... fall through ... */
13668 case LABEL_REF:
13669 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
13670 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13671 pool. */
13672 case CONST:
13673 case SYMBOL_REF:
13674 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13675 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13677 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13679 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13680 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13681 break;
13683 /* We used to emit DW_OP_addr here, but that's wrong, since
13684 DW_OP_addr should be relocated by the debug info consumer,
13685 while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address operand should not. */
13686 temp = new_loc_descr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4
13687 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u, 0, 0);
13688 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13689 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13690 temp->dtprel = true;
13692 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13693 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13695 break;
13698 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13699 break;
13701 symref:
13702 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13703 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13704 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13705 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13706 break;
13708 case CONCAT:
13709 case CONCATN:
13710 case VAR_LOCATION:
13711 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
13712 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13713 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13714 return 0;
13716 case PRE_MODIFY:
13717 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13718 PLUS code below. */
13719 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13720 goto plus;
13722 case PRE_INC:
13723 case PRE_DEC:
13724 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13725 below. */
13726 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13727 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13728 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
13729 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
13731 /* ... fall through ... */
13733 case PLUS:
13734 plus:
13735 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
13736 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13737 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13738 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13739 else
13741 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13742 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13743 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13744 break;
13746 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13747 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13748 else
13750 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result2
13751 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13752 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13753 if (mem_loc_result2 == 0)
13754 break;
13755 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, mem_loc_result2);
13756 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13757 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13760 break;
13762 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13763 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13764 case MINUS:
13765 op = DW_OP_minus;
13766 goto do_binop;
13768 case MULT:
13769 op = DW_OP_mul;
13770 goto do_binop;
13772 case DIV:
13773 op = DW_OP_div;
13774 goto do_binop;
13776 case UMOD:
13777 op = DW_OP_mod;
13778 goto do_binop;
13780 case ASHIFT:
13781 op = DW_OP_shl;
13782 goto do_binop;
13784 case ASHIFTRT:
13785 op = DW_OP_shra;
13786 goto do_binop;
13788 case LSHIFTRT:
13789 op = DW_OP_shr;
13790 goto do_binop;
13792 case AND:
13793 op = DW_OP_and;
13794 goto do_binop;
13796 case IOR:
13797 op = DW_OP_or;
13798 goto do_binop;
13800 case XOR:
13801 op = DW_OP_xor;
13802 goto do_binop;
13804 do_binop:
13805 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13806 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13807 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13808 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13810 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13811 break;
13813 mem_loc_result = op0;
13814 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13815 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13816 break;
13818 case MOD:
13819 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13820 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13821 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13822 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13824 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13825 break;
13827 mem_loc_result = op0;
13828 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13829 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13830 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13831 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13832 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13833 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13834 break;
13836 case NOT:
13837 op = DW_OP_not;
13838 goto do_unop;
13840 case ABS:
13841 op = DW_OP_abs;
13842 goto do_unop;
13844 case NEG:
13845 op = DW_OP_neg;
13846 goto do_unop;
13848 do_unop:
13849 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13850 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13852 if (op0 == 0)
13853 break;
13855 mem_loc_result = op0;
13856 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13857 break;
13859 case CONST_INT:
13860 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13861 break;
13863 case EQ:
13864 op = DW_OP_eq;
13865 goto do_scompare;
13867 case GE:
13868 op = DW_OP_ge;
13869 goto do_scompare;
13871 case GT:
13872 op = DW_OP_gt;
13873 goto do_scompare;
13875 case LE:
13876 op = DW_OP_le;
13877 goto do_scompare;
13879 case LT:
13880 op = DW_OP_lt;
13881 goto do_scompare;
13883 case NE:
13884 op = DW_OP_ne;
13885 goto do_scompare;
13887 do_scompare:
13888 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13889 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13890 break;
13891 else
13893 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13895 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13896 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13897 if (op_mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13898 break;
13900 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13901 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13902 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13903 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13905 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13906 break;
13908 if (op_mode != VOIDmode
13909 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13911 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode);
13912 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13913 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
13914 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
13915 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
13917 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13918 for (last0 = op0;
13919 last0->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13920 last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13922 for (last1 = op1;
13923 last1->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13924 last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13926 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
13927 whether they are zero extended or not. */
13928 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13929 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13930 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13931 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13932 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13933 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13934 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13935 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13936 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13937 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13938 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13939 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
13940 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13941 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13942 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
13943 goto do_compare;
13945 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13946 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13947 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13948 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13949 else
13951 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13952 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13957 do_compare:
13958 mem_loc_result = op0;
13959 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13960 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13961 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13963 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13964 int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13965 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13967 break;
13969 case GEU:
13970 op = DW_OP_ge;
13971 goto do_ucompare;
13973 case GTU:
13974 op = DW_OP_gt;
13975 goto do_ucompare;
13977 case LEU:
13978 op = DW_OP_le;
13979 goto do_ucompare;
13981 case LTU:
13982 op = DW_OP_lt;
13983 goto do_ucompare;
13985 do_ucompare:
13986 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13987 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13988 break;
13989 else
13991 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13993 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13994 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13995 if (op_mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13996 break;
13998 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13999 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14000 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
14001 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14003 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14004 break;
14006 if (op_mode != VOIDmode
14007 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14009 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14010 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14011 for (last0 = op0;
14012 last0->dw_loc_next != NULL;
14013 last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14015 for (last1 = op1;
14016 last1->dw_loc_next != NULL;
14017 last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14019 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14020 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14021 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14022 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14023 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
14024 > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14026 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14027 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14029 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14030 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14031 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14032 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14033 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
14034 > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14036 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14037 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14040 else
14042 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14043 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14044 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14045 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14046 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14047 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14048 else
14049 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14050 bias, 0));
14053 goto do_compare;
14055 case SMIN:
14056 case SMAX:
14057 case UMIN:
14058 case UMAX:
14059 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
14060 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14061 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14062 break;
14064 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
14065 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14066 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
14067 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14069 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14070 break;
14072 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14073 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14074 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14075 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14077 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14079 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
14080 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14081 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14082 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14083 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14085 else
14087 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14088 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14089 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14090 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14093 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14095 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14096 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
14097 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14098 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14099 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14100 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14101 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14104 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14105 op = DW_OP_lt;
14106 else
14107 op = DW_OP_gt;
14108 mem_loc_result = op0;
14109 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
14110 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14112 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14114 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14115 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
14116 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14117 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14118 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
14119 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14120 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14122 break;
14124 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
14125 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
14126 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14127 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14128 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14129 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14130 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)))
14131 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14132 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14134 int shift, size;
14135 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
14136 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14137 if (op0 == 0)
14138 break;
14139 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
14140 op = DW_OP_shra;
14141 else
14142 op = DW_OP_shr;
14143 mem_loc_result = op0;
14144 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14145 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
14146 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14147 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14148 - shift - size;
14149 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14151 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14152 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14153 - shift - size));
14154 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14156 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14158 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14159 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
14160 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14163 break;
14165 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
14167 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
14168 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
14169 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14170 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
14171 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14172 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode,
14173 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14174 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
14175 break;
14177 mem_loc_result = op1;
14178 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
14179 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
14180 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14181 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
14182 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14183 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14184 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
14185 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14186 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14188 break;
14190 case COMPARE:
14191 case ROTATE:
14192 case ROTATERT:
14193 case TRUNCATE:
14194 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
14195 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
14196 natively. */
14197 case SS_MULT:
14198 case US_MULT:
14199 case SS_DIV:
14200 case US_DIV:
14201 case SS_PLUS:
14202 case US_PLUS:
14203 case SS_MINUS:
14204 case US_MINUS:
14205 case SS_NEG:
14206 case US_NEG:
14207 case SS_ABS:
14208 case SS_ASHIFT:
14209 case US_ASHIFT:
14210 case SS_TRUNCATE:
14211 case US_TRUNCATE:
14212 case UDIV:
14213 case UNORDERED:
14214 case ORDERED:
14215 case UNEQ:
14216 case UNGE:
14217 case UNGT:
14218 case UNLE:
14219 case UNLT:
14220 case LTGT:
14221 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
14222 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
14223 case FLOAT:
14224 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
14225 case FIX:
14226 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
14227 case FRACT_CONVERT:
14228 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
14229 case SAT_FRACT:
14230 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
14231 case SQRT:
14232 case BSWAP:
14233 case FFS:
14234 case CLZ:
14235 case CTZ:
14236 case POPCOUNT:
14237 case PARITY:
14238 case ASM_OPERANDS:
14239 case VEC_MERGE:
14240 case VEC_SELECT:
14241 case VEC_CONCAT:
14242 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
14243 case UNSPEC:
14244 case HIGH:
14245 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
14246 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
14247 TLS UNSPECs. */
14248 break;
14250 case CONST_STRING:
14251 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
14252 goto symref;
14254 default:
14255 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
14256 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
14257 gcc_unreachable ();
14258 #else
14259 break;
14260 #endif
14263 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14264 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14266 return mem_loc_result;
14269 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
14270 This is typically a complex variable. */
14272 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14273 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
14275 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14276 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
14277 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14278 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
14279 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14281 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
14282 return 0;
14284 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
14285 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
14287 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
14288 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
14290 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14291 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14293 return cc_loc_result;
14296 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
14297 locations. */
14299 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14300 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
14302 unsigned int i;
14303 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14304 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
14306 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
14308 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
14309 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
14311 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14312 if (ref == NULL)
14313 return NULL;
14315 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
14316 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
14319 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14320 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14322 return cc_loc_result;
14325 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
14326 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
14328 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14329 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14331 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14332 dw_die_ref ref;
14334 if (dwarf_strict)
14335 return NULL;
14336 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
14337 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
14338 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
14339 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
14340 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
14341 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
14342 if (ref)
14344 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14345 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14346 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14348 else
14350 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14351 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
14353 return ret;
14356 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
14357 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
14358 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
14359 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
14360 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
14362 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
14363 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
14364 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
14366 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
14368 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14369 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14370 enum var_init_status initialized)
14372 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14374 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14376 case SUBREG:
14377 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14378 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14379 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14380 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14381 contains the given subreg. */
14382 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl), mode, initialized);
14383 break;
14385 case REG:
14386 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14387 break;
14389 case MEM:
14390 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
14391 initialized);
14392 if (loc_result == NULL)
14393 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14394 if (loc_result == NULL)
14396 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14397 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14398 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
14400 break;
14402 case CONCAT:
14403 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
14404 initialized);
14405 break;
14407 case CONCATN:
14408 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14409 break;
14411 case VAR_LOCATION:
14412 /* Single part. */
14413 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
14415 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
14416 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14417 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
14418 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
14419 break;
14422 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14423 /* FALLTHRU */
14425 case PARALLEL:
14427 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
14428 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
14429 enum machine_mode mode;
14430 int i;
14432 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
14433 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
14434 VOIDmode, initialized);
14435 if (loc_result == NULL)
14436 return NULL;
14437 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
14438 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14439 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
14441 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14443 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
14444 VOIDmode, initialized);
14445 if (temp == NULL)
14446 return NULL;
14447 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
14448 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
14449 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14452 break;
14454 case CONST_INT:
14455 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
14456 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
14457 INTVAL (rtl));
14458 break;
14460 case CONST_DOUBLE:
14461 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14462 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14464 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14466 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14468 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
14469 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
14470 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
14471 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
14472 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14473 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14474 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
14476 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
14477 unsigned char *array
14478 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
14480 insert_float (rtl, array);
14481 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14482 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
14483 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
14484 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14486 else
14488 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
14489 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
14490 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
14493 break;
14495 case CONST_VECTOR:
14496 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14497 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14499 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14501 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
14502 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
14503 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
14504 ggc_alloc_atomic (length * elt_size);
14505 unsigned int i;
14506 unsigned char *p;
14508 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14509 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
14511 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
14512 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14514 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14515 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
14517 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
14518 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
14519 else
14521 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
14522 insert_double (val, p);
14525 break;
14527 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
14528 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14530 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14531 insert_float (elt, p);
14533 break;
14535 default:
14536 gcc_unreachable ();
14539 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14540 length * elt_size, 0);
14541 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14542 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
14543 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
14544 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14546 break;
14548 case CONST:
14549 if (mode == VOIDmode
14550 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
14551 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
14552 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
14554 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
14555 break;
14557 /* FALLTHROUGH */
14558 case SYMBOL_REF:
14559 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14560 break;
14561 case LABEL_REF:
14562 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14563 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14565 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14566 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14567 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14568 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14569 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
14571 break;
14573 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14574 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
14575 break;
14577 case PLUS:
14578 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
14579 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14581 loc_result
14582 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14583 break;
14585 /* FALLTHRU */
14586 default:
14587 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
14588 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14589 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14591 /* Value expression. */
14592 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
14593 if (loc_result)
14594 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14595 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14597 break;
14600 return loc_result;
14603 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
14604 address ranges where a given location is valid.
14605 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
14606 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
14607 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
14608 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
14610 static const char *
14611 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
14613 const char *secname;
14615 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
14617 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
14618 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
14620 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
14622 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
14623 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
14625 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
14626 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
14627 else
14628 secname = text_section_label;
14630 return secname;
14633 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
14635 static bool
14636 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
14638 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
14639 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
14640 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
14643 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14644 for VARLOC. */
14646 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14647 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
14648 enum var_init_status initialized)
14650 int have_address = 0;
14651 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14652 enum machine_mode mode;
14654 if (want_address != 2)
14656 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
14657 /* Single part. */
14658 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14660 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14661 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14662 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14663 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
14664 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14666 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14667 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, mode, initialized);
14668 if (descr)
14669 have_address = 1;
14670 else
14672 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
14673 if (x != varloc)
14674 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, initialized);
14677 else
14678 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14680 else
14681 return 0;
14683 else
14685 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
14686 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
14687 else
14688 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
14689 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14690 have_address = 1;
14693 if (!descr)
14694 return 0;
14696 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14697 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14699 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14701 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14702 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14703 return 0;
14705 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14706 have_address = 1;
14708 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14709 if (want_address && !have_address)
14711 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14712 "Want address and only have value");
14713 return 0;
14716 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14717 if (!want_address && have_address)
14719 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14720 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14722 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14724 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14725 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14726 return 0;
14728 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14729 op = DW_OP_deref;
14730 else
14731 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14733 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14736 return descr;
14739 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
14740 if it is not possible. */
14742 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14743 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14745 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
14746 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
14747 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14748 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
14749 else
14750 return NULL;
14753 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14754 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
14756 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14757 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
14759 rtx p;
14760 unsigned int padsize = 0;
14761 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
14762 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
14763 rtx varloc;
14764 enum var_init_status initialized;
14766 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
14767 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
14768 return NULL;
14770 decl_size = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1);
14771 descr = NULL;
14772 descr_tail = &descr;
14774 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
14776 unsigned int bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
14777 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
14778 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
14779 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
14780 unsigned int opsize = 0;
14782 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
14783 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
14785 padsize += bitsize;
14786 continue;
14788 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
14789 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
14790 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
14791 if (cur_descr == NULL)
14793 padsize += bitsize;
14794 continue;
14797 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
14798 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
14799 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
14800 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
14801 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
14802 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
14804 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
14805 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14806 last = *tail;
14808 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
14810 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
14811 last = *tail;
14814 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
14816 padsize += bitsize;
14817 continue;
14820 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
14821 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
14822 if (padsize)
14824 if (padsize > decl_size)
14825 return NULL;
14826 decl_size -= padsize;
14827 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
14828 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14829 return NULL;
14830 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14831 padsize = 0;
14833 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
14834 descr_tail = tail;
14835 if (bitsize > decl_size)
14836 return NULL;
14837 decl_size -= bitsize;
14838 if (last == NULL)
14840 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14841 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
14842 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14844 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14845 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14846 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14850 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
14851 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
14852 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
14853 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14854 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
14855 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
14856 else
14857 break;
14859 while (1);
14860 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
14861 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
14862 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
14863 adjustment. */
14864 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14866 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
14867 = INTVAL (MEM_SIZE (varloc)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14868 if (memsize != bitsize)
14870 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
14871 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
14872 return NULL;
14873 if (memsize < bitsize)
14874 return NULL;
14875 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14876 offset = memsize - bitsize;
14880 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
14881 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14882 return NULL;
14883 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14887 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
14888 the decl. */
14889 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
14891 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
14892 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14893 return NULL;
14895 return descr;
14898 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
14899 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
14900 function. */
14902 static dw_loc_list_ref
14903 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
14905 const char *endname, *secname;
14906 rtx varloc;
14907 enum var_init_status initialized;
14908 struct var_loc_node *node;
14909 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14910 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14911 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
14912 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
14914 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
14915 actually construct the list of locations.
14916 The first location information is what is passed to the
14917 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
14918 locations just get added on to that list.
14919 Note that we only know the start address for a location
14920 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
14921 the range [current location start, next location start].
14922 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
14923 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
14925 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
14927 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
14928 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
14929 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
14931 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14933 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
14934 inside DWARF expressions. */
14935 if (want_address != 2)
14936 continue;
14937 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14938 if (descr == NULL)
14939 continue;
14941 else
14943 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14944 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14945 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14947 if (descr)
14949 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14950 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14951 if (node->next)
14952 endname = node->next->label;
14953 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
14954 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
14955 else if (!current_function_decl)
14956 endname = text_end_label;
14957 else
14959 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
14960 current_function_funcdef_no);
14961 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14964 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14965 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14969 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
14970 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
14971 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
14972 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
14973 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
14974 available. */
14975 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
14976 gen_llsym (list);
14978 return list;
14981 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14982 as location description. */
14984 static bool
14985 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14987 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
14988 return !list->ll_symbol;
14991 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14993 static void
14994 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14996 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14997 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14998 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14999 while (list)
15001 copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
15002 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
15003 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
15004 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
15006 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
15007 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
15008 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
15009 copy = new_copy;
15011 list = list->dw_loc_next;
15015 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
15016 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
15017 to expression in RET on each possition in program.
15018 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
15020 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
15021 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
15022 and merging them that will need some additional work.
15023 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
15024 structures. */
15026 static void
15027 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
15029 if (!list)
15030 return;
15031 if (!*ret)
15033 *ret = list;
15034 return;
15036 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
15038 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
15039 return;
15041 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
15043 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
15044 *ret = list;
15045 return;
15047 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
15048 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
15049 " location lists.\n");
15050 *ret = NULL;
15051 return;
15054 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
15055 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
15057 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15058 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
15060 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
15061 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
15062 enum machine_mode mode;
15064 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
15066 gcc_assert (!rtl);
15067 return 0;
15069 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
15071 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
15072 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
15073 populated. */
15074 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
15076 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15077 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
15078 return 0;
15080 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15081 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15082 return mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15085 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
15086 by looking for innder INDIRECT_REF expression and turing it
15087 into simple arithmetics. */
15089 static dw_loc_list_ref
15090 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
15092 tree obj, offset;
15093 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
15094 enum machine_mode mode;
15095 int volatilep;
15096 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15097 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15099 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
15100 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
15101 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
15102 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
15103 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
15105 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
15106 return 0;
15108 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
15110 expansion_failed (obj,
15111 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
15112 return 0;
15114 if (!offset && !bitpos)
15115 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
15116 else if (toplev
15117 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15118 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15120 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
15121 if (!list_ret)
15122 return 0;
15123 if (offset)
15125 /* Variable offset. */
15126 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
15127 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15128 return 0;
15129 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15130 if (!list_ret)
15131 return 0;
15132 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15133 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15135 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15136 if (bytepos > 0)
15137 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15138 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15139 bytepos, 0));
15140 else if (bytepos < 0)
15141 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15142 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15143 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15145 return list_ret;
15149 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
15150 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
15151 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
15152 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
15153 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
15154 to refer to register values). */
15156 static dw_loc_list_ref
15157 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
15159 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
15160 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15161 int have_address = 0;
15162 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15164 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
15165 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
15166 problem... */
15168 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
15170 case ERROR_MARK:
15171 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
15172 return 0;
15174 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
15175 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
15176 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
15177 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
15178 the names of types. */
15179 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
15180 return 0;
15182 case CALL_EXPR:
15183 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
15184 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15185 return 0;
15187 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
15188 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
15189 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
15190 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
15191 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
15192 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15193 return 0;
15195 case ADDR_EXPR:
15196 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
15197 e.g. for &this->field. */
15198 if (want_address)
15200 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
15201 (loc, want_address == 2);
15202 if (list_ret)
15203 have_address = 1;
15204 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
15205 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15206 have_address = 1;
15208 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
15209 if (!list_ret && !ret)
15210 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
15211 else
15213 if (want_address)
15214 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
15215 return NULL;
15217 break;
15219 case VAR_DECL:
15220 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
15222 rtx rtl;
15223 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
15224 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
15225 bool dtprel = false;
15227 if (targetm.have_tls)
15229 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
15230 data. */
15231 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15232 return 0;
15234 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
15235 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
15236 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
15237 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
15238 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
15239 operand shouldn't be. */
15240 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
15241 return 0;
15242 first_op = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u;
15243 dtprel = true;
15244 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
15246 else
15248 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
15249 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
15250 return 0;
15251 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
15252 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
15253 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
15254 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
15255 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
15256 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
15257 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
15260 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15261 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15262 return 0;
15264 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
15265 return 0;
15266 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15267 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
15268 return 0;
15270 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
15271 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
15272 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
15273 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
15275 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
15276 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15278 have_address = 1;
15279 break;
15281 /* FALLTHRU */
15283 case PARM_DECL:
15284 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
15285 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
15286 want_address);
15287 /* FALLTHRU */
15289 case RESULT_DECL:
15290 case FUNCTION_DECL:
15292 rtx rtl;
15293 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
15295 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
15297 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
15298 have_address = want_address != 0;
15299 break;
15301 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15302 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15304 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
15305 return 0;
15307 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
15309 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15310 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15311 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
15312 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
15314 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15316 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
15317 return 0;
15319 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15321 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
15322 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
15323 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
15325 else
15327 enum machine_mode mode;
15329 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
15330 if (want_address == 2)
15332 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
15333 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15334 have_address = 1;
15336 else
15338 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15339 if (MEM_P (rtl))
15341 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15342 have_address = 1;
15344 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15346 if (!ret)
15347 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
15348 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
15351 break;
15353 case MEM_REF:
15354 /* ??? FIXME. */
15355 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
15356 return 0;
15357 /* Fallthru. */
15358 case INDIRECT_REF:
15359 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15360 have_address = 1;
15361 break;
15363 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
15364 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
15366 CASE_CONVERT:
15367 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15368 case SAVE_EXPR:
15369 case MODIFY_EXPR:
15370 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
15372 case COMPONENT_REF:
15373 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
15374 case ARRAY_REF:
15375 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
15376 case REALPART_EXPR:
15377 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
15379 tree obj, offset;
15380 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
15381 enum machine_mode mode;
15382 int volatilep;
15383 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15385 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
15386 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
15388 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
15390 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
15391 want_address == 2
15392 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
15393 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
15394 for nonzero bitpos. */
15395 if (list_ret == 0)
15396 return 0;
15397 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
15399 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15400 "bitfield access");
15401 return 0;
15404 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
15406 /* Variable offset. */
15407 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
15408 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15409 return 0;
15410 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15411 if (!list_ret)
15412 return 0;
15413 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15416 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15417 if (bytepos > 0)
15418 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
15419 else if (bytepos < 0)
15420 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15422 have_address = 1;
15423 break;
15426 case INTEGER_CST:
15427 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
15428 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15429 have_address = 1;
15430 else if (want_address == 2
15431 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
15432 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
15433 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
15434 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
15435 have_address = 1;
15436 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
15437 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
15438 else
15440 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15441 "Integer operand is not host integer");
15442 return 0;
15444 break;
15446 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15447 case REAL_CST:
15448 case STRING_CST:
15449 case COMPLEX_CST:
15450 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15451 have_address = 1;
15452 else
15453 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
15454 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15455 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
15456 break;
15458 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
15459 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
15460 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
15461 op = DW_OP_and;
15462 goto do_binop;
15464 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
15465 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
15466 op = DW_OP_xor;
15467 goto do_binop;
15469 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
15470 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
15471 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
15472 op = DW_OP_or;
15473 goto do_binop;
15475 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
15476 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
15477 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
15478 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
15479 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15480 return 0;
15481 op = DW_OP_div;
15482 goto do_binop;
15484 case MINUS_EXPR:
15485 op = DW_OP_minus;
15486 goto do_binop;
15488 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
15489 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
15490 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
15491 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
15492 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15494 op = DW_OP_mod;
15495 goto do_binop;
15497 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15498 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15499 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
15500 return 0;
15502 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15503 if (list_ret == 0)
15504 return 0;
15505 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15506 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15507 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15508 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15509 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15510 break;
15512 case MULT_EXPR:
15513 op = DW_OP_mul;
15514 goto do_binop;
15516 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
15517 op = DW_OP_shl;
15518 goto do_binop;
15520 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
15521 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
15522 goto do_binop;
15524 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
15525 case PLUS_EXPR:
15526 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
15528 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15529 if (list_ret == 0)
15530 return 0;
15532 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
15533 break;
15536 op = DW_OP_plus;
15537 goto do_binop;
15539 case LE_EXPR:
15540 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15541 return 0;
15543 op = DW_OP_le;
15544 goto do_binop;
15546 case GE_EXPR:
15547 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15548 return 0;
15550 op = DW_OP_ge;
15551 goto do_binop;
15553 case LT_EXPR:
15554 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15555 return 0;
15557 op = DW_OP_lt;
15558 goto do_binop;
15560 case GT_EXPR:
15561 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15562 return 0;
15564 op = DW_OP_gt;
15565 goto do_binop;
15567 case EQ_EXPR:
15568 op = DW_OP_eq;
15569 goto do_binop;
15571 case NE_EXPR:
15572 op = DW_OP_ne;
15573 goto do_binop;
15575 do_binop:
15576 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15577 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15578 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
15579 return 0;
15581 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15582 if (list_ret == 0)
15583 return 0;
15584 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15585 break;
15587 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
15588 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
15589 op = DW_OP_not;
15590 goto do_unop;
15592 case ABS_EXPR:
15593 op = DW_OP_abs;
15594 goto do_unop;
15596 case NEGATE_EXPR:
15597 op = DW_OP_neg;
15598 goto do_unop;
15600 do_unop:
15601 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15602 if (list_ret == 0)
15603 return 0;
15605 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15606 break;
15608 case MIN_EXPR:
15609 case MAX_EXPR:
15611 const enum tree_code code =
15612 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
15614 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
15615 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
15616 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
15617 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
15620 /* ... fall through ... */
15622 case COND_EXPR:
15624 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
15625 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15626 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
15627 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
15628 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
15630 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15631 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
15632 return 0;
15634 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15635 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
15637 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
15638 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15639 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
15641 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
15642 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15643 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
15645 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
15646 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
15647 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
15648 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15649 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
15651 break;
15653 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
15654 return 0;
15656 default:
15657 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
15658 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
15659 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
15660 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
15662 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15663 "language specific tree node");
15664 return 0;
15667 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
15668 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
15669 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
15670 gcc_unreachable ();
15671 #else
15672 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
15673 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
15674 return NULL;
15675 #endif
15678 if (!ret && !list_ret)
15679 return 0;
15681 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
15682 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15684 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15686 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15687 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15688 return 0;
15690 if (ret)
15691 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15692 else
15693 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15694 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15695 have_address = 1;
15697 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
15698 if (want_address && !have_address)
15700 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15701 "Want address and only have value");
15702 return 0;
15705 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
15707 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
15708 if (!want_address && have_address)
15710 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15712 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
15714 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15715 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15716 return 0;
15718 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15719 op = DW_OP_deref;
15720 else
15721 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
15723 if (ret)
15724 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15725 else
15726 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15728 if (ret)
15729 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
15731 return list_ret;
15734 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
15735 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15736 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
15738 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
15739 if (!ret)
15740 return NULL;
15741 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
15743 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15744 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
15745 return NULL;
15747 return ret->expr;
15750 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
15751 which is not less than the value itself. */
15753 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
15754 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
15756 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
15759 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
15760 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
15761 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
15762 ERROR_MARK node. */
15764 static inline tree
15765 field_type (const_tree decl)
15767 tree type;
15769 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15770 return integer_type_node;
15772 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
15773 if (type == NULL_TREE)
15774 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15776 return type;
15779 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
15780 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
15781 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
15783 static inline unsigned
15784 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
15786 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15789 static inline unsigned
15790 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
15792 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15795 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
15797 static inline double_int
15798 round_up_to_align (double_int t, unsigned int align)
15800 double_int alignd = uhwi_to_double_int (align);
15801 t = double_int_add (t, alignd);
15802 t = double_int_add (t, double_int_minus_one);
15803 t = double_int_div (t, alignd, true, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
15804 t = double_int_mul (t, alignd);
15805 return t;
15808 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
15809 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
15810 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
15811 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
15812 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
15813 just yet). */
15815 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15816 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
15818 double_int object_offset_in_bits;
15819 double_int object_offset_in_bytes;
15820 double_int bitpos_int;
15822 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15823 return 0;
15825 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
15827 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
15828 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
15829 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
15830 if (TREE_CODE (bit_position (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
15831 return 0;
15833 bitpos_int = tree_to_double_int (bit_position (decl));
15835 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
15836 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
15838 tree type;
15839 tree field_size_tree;
15840 double_int deepest_bitpos;
15841 double_int field_size_in_bits;
15842 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
15843 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
15844 double_int type_size_in_bits;
15846 type = field_type (decl);
15847 type_size_in_bits = double_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
15848 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
15850 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
15852 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
15853 a flexible array member. */
15854 if (!field_size_tree)
15855 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
15857 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
15858 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
15859 field_size_in_bits = tree_to_double_int (field_size_tree);
15860 else
15861 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
15863 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
15865 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
15866 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
15867 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
15868 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
15869 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
15870 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
15871 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
15872 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
15873 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
15875 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
15877 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
15878 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
15879 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
15880 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
15881 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
15882 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
15883 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
15884 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
15885 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
15886 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
15887 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
15889 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
15890 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
15891 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
15892 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
15893 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
15894 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
15895 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
15896 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
15897 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
15898 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
15899 structure type.)
15901 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
15902 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
15903 must have believed that the containing object started (within
15904 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
15905 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
15906 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
15907 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
15909 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
15910 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
15911 deepest_bitpos = double_int_add (bitpos_int, field_size_in_bits);
15913 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
15914 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
15915 be. */
15916 object_offset_in_bits
15917 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
15919 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
15920 bitfields. */
15921 object_offset_in_bits
15922 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
15924 if (double_int_ucmp (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int) > 0)
15926 object_offset_in_bits
15927 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
15929 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
15930 object_offset_in_bits
15931 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
15934 else
15935 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
15936 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
15938 object_offset_in_bytes
15939 = double_int_div (object_offset_in_bits,
15940 uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_UNIT), true,
15941 TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
15942 return double_int_to_shwi (object_offset_in_bytes);
15945 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
15946 associated with them. */
15948 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
15950 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
15951 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
15952 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
15954 static inline void
15955 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
15956 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
15958 if (descr == 0)
15959 return;
15960 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
15961 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
15962 else
15963 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
15966 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
15968 static void
15969 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15971 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
15972 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
15973 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
15974 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
15975 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
15976 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
15978 if (dwarf_version == 2
15979 || die->die_parent == NULL
15980 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
15981 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
15983 else if (dwarf_version > 2
15984 && die->die_parent
15985 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
15986 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
15989 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
15990 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
15991 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
15992 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
15993 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
15994 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
15995 function above).
15997 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
15998 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
15999 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16000 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
16001 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
16002 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
16003 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
16004 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
16005 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
16006 function below.) */
16008 static void
16009 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16011 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
16012 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
16014 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
16016 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
16017 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
16019 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
16020 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
16021 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
16022 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
16024 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
16026 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
16028 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
16030 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
16031 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
16032 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16034 /* Extract the vtable address. */
16035 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16036 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16038 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
16039 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
16040 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
16042 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
16043 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16044 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
16045 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16047 /* Extract the offset. */
16048 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16049 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16051 /* Add it to the object address. */
16052 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
16053 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16055 else
16056 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
16058 else
16059 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
16061 if (! loc_descr)
16063 if (dwarf_version > 2)
16065 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
16066 if (offset < 0)
16067 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16068 else
16069 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16070 return;
16072 else
16074 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16076 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
16077 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
16078 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
16080 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16081 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
16082 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
16083 stack. */
16084 op = DW_OP_constu;
16085 #else
16086 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
16087 #endif
16089 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
16093 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
16096 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
16098 static void
16099 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
16101 while (size != 0)
16103 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
16104 val >>= 8;
16105 --size;
16109 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
16111 static HOST_WIDE_INT
16112 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
16114 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
16116 src += size;
16117 while (size != 0)
16119 val <<= 8;
16120 val |= *--src & 0xff;
16121 --size;
16123 return val;
16126 /* Writes double_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
16128 static void
16129 insert_double (double_int val, unsigned char *dest)
16131 unsigned char *p0 = dest;
16132 unsigned char *p1 = dest + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
16134 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16136 p0 = p1;
16137 p1 = dest;
16140 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.low, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
16141 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.high, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
16144 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
16146 static void
16147 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
16149 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
16150 long val[4];
16151 int i;
16153 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
16154 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
16156 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
16157 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
16159 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
16160 array += 4;
16164 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
16165 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
16166 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
16167 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
16168 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
16170 static bool
16171 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
16173 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
16175 case CONST_INT:
16177 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
16179 if (val < 0)
16180 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
16181 else
16182 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
16184 return true;
16186 case CONST_DOUBLE:
16187 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
16188 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
16189 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
16190 represented. */
16192 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16194 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
16196 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
16197 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
16199 insert_float (rtl, array);
16200 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
16202 else
16203 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
16204 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
16206 return true;
16208 case CONST_VECTOR:
16210 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16211 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
16212 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
16213 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic
16214 (length * elt_size);
16215 unsigned int i;
16216 unsigned char *p;
16218 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16220 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16221 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16223 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16224 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
16226 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
16227 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
16228 else
16230 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
16231 insert_double (val, p);
16234 break;
16236 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16237 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16239 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16240 insert_float (elt, p);
16242 break;
16244 default:
16245 gcc_unreachable ();
16248 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
16250 return true;
16252 case CONST_STRING:
16253 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16255 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
16256 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
16257 rtl_addr:
16258 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
16259 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
16260 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
16261 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16262 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
16263 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
16264 return true;
16266 return false;
16268 case CONST:
16269 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
16270 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
16271 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16272 case SYMBOL_REF:
16273 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16274 return false;
16275 case LABEL_REF:
16276 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16277 goto rtl_addr;
16278 return false;
16280 case PLUS:
16281 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
16282 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
16283 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
16284 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
16285 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
16286 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
16287 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
16288 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
16289 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
16290 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
16291 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
16292 return false;
16294 case HIGH:
16295 case CONST_FIXED:
16296 return false;
16298 case MEM:
16299 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
16300 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
16301 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
16303 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
16304 return true;
16306 return false;
16308 default:
16309 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
16310 gcc_unreachable ();
16312 return false;
16315 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
16316 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
16317 output). */
16318 static tree
16319 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
16320 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16322 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
16323 *walk_subtrees = 0;
16325 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
16326 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
16327 return *tp;
16328 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
16329 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
16330 be conservative. */
16331 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
16332 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
16333 return *tp;
16334 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
16336 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (*tp);
16337 if (!node || !node->needed)
16338 return *tp;
16340 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
16341 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
16343 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
16344 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
16345 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
16346 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
16347 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
16348 return *tp;
16350 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
16351 return *tp;
16353 return NULL_TREE;
16356 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
16357 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
16359 static rtx
16360 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
16362 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
16364 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
16365 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
16366 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16368 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
16369 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
16370 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
16372 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
16373 && domain
16374 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
16375 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
16376 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
16377 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
16378 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
16380 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
16381 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
16382 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
16383 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
16386 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
16387 CONCAT: FIXME! */
16388 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
16390 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
16391 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
16392 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
16393 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
16395 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
16396 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
16397 reference variables which won't be output. */
16398 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
16399 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
16401 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
16402 possible. */
16403 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
16404 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
16406 case VECTOR_CST:
16407 break;
16408 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16409 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
16411 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
16412 bool constant_p = true;
16413 tree value;
16414 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
16416 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
16417 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
16418 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
16419 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
16420 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
16422 constant_p = false;
16423 break;
16426 if (constant_p)
16428 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
16429 break;
16432 /* FALLTHRU */
16434 default:
16435 return NULL;
16438 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
16440 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
16441 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
16444 return rtl;
16447 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
16449 static rtx
16450 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
16452 rtx rtl;
16454 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
16455 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
16456 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
16458 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
16459 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
16460 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
16461 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
16462 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
16463 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
16464 referenced within the function.
16466 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
16467 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
16468 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
16469 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
16471 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
16472 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
16473 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
16474 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
16475 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
16476 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
16478 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
16479 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
16480 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
16481 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
16482 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
16483 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
16484 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
16485 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
16486 output at debug-time.
16488 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
16489 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
16490 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
16491 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
16492 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
16493 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
16494 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
16495 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
16496 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
16497 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
16498 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
16499 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
16500 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
16502 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
16503 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
16504 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
16505 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
16506 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
16507 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
16508 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
16509 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
16510 I'd like to fix it.
16512 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
16513 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
16514 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
16515 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
16516 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
16517 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
16518 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
16519 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
16520 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
16521 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
16522 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
16524 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
16525 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
16527 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
16528 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
16529 fixed registers. */
16530 if (! reload_completed)
16532 if (rtl
16533 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
16534 || (MEM_P (rtl)
16535 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
16536 || (REG_P (rtl)
16537 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16538 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
16540 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
16541 return rtl;
16543 rtl = NULL_RTX;
16545 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
16547 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
16549 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
16550 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
16551 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
16552 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
16554 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
16555 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
16556 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
16557 if (dmode == pmode)
16558 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
16559 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
16560 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
16561 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
16563 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
16564 if (REG_P (inc))
16565 rtl = inc;
16566 else if (MEM_P (inc))
16568 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16569 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
16570 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
16571 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
16572 else
16573 rtl = inc;
16578 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
16579 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
16580 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
16581 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
16582 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
16583 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
16584 thing to do. */
16585 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
16586 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
16587 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16588 /* Not passed in memory. */
16589 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
16590 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
16591 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16592 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
16593 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
16594 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
16595 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
16596 #endif
16598 /* Big endian correction check. */
16599 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
16600 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
16601 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
16602 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
16604 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
16605 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
16607 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16608 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
16611 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16612 && rtl
16613 && MEM_P (rtl)
16614 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
16615 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16617 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
16618 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
16620 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
16621 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
16622 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
16623 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
16624 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
16625 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
16626 if (rsize > dsize)
16627 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16628 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
16631 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
16632 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
16633 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
16634 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
16635 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
16637 if (rtl)
16638 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
16640 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
16641 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
16642 code, and thus is not emitted. */
16643 if (rtl)
16644 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
16646 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
16647 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
16648 it. */
16649 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
16650 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16651 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
16652 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
16653 && DECL_NAME (decl)
16654 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
16655 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
16657 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
16658 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
16659 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
16660 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
16661 rtl = NULL_RTX;
16664 return rtl;
16667 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
16668 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
16669 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
16671 static tree
16672 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
16674 tree val_expr, cvar;
16675 enum machine_mode mode;
16676 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
16677 tree offset;
16678 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
16680 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
16681 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
16682 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
16683 be handled as such. */
16684 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
16685 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
16686 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
16687 || !is_fortran ())
16688 return NULL_TREE;
16690 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
16691 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
16692 return NULL_TREE;
16694 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
16695 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
16697 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
16698 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
16699 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
16700 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
16701 return NULL_TREE;
16703 *value = 0;
16704 if (offset != NULL)
16706 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
16707 return NULL_TREE;
16708 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
16710 if (bitpos != 0)
16711 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16713 return cvar;
16716 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
16717 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
16718 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
16719 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
16720 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
16721 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
16722 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
16723 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
16724 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
16725 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
16727 static bool
16728 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
16729 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
16731 rtx rtl;
16732 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16733 var_loc_list *loc_list;
16735 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16736 return false;
16738 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16739 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
16741 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
16742 the location. */
16744 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
16745 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16746 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16747 return true;
16749 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
16750 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
16751 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
16752 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
16753 if (loc_list
16754 && loc_list->first
16755 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
16756 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
16757 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
16758 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
16760 struct var_loc_node *node;
16762 node = loc_list->first;
16763 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
16764 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
16765 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16766 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16767 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16768 return true;
16770 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
16771 if (list)
16773 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
16774 return true;
16776 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
16777 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
16778 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
16781 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
16783 static void
16784 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
16786 deferred_locations entry;
16787 entry.variable = variable;
16788 entry.die = die;
16789 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
16792 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
16793 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
16795 static bool
16796 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
16798 tree type;
16800 if (init == NULL_TREE)
16801 return false;
16803 STRIP_NOPS (init);
16804 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
16806 case STRING_CST:
16807 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16808 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16810 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
16811 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
16813 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
16814 return false;
16815 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16816 return false;
16817 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
16819 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
16820 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16821 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
16822 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16824 else
16825 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
16826 return true;
16828 return false;
16829 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16830 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16831 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16832 return false;
16833 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16835 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
16836 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16837 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
16838 constructor_elt *ce;
16840 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
16841 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
16842 return false;
16844 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
16845 if (fieldsize <= 0)
16846 return false;
16848 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
16849 memset (array, '\0', size);
16850 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
16852 tree val = ce->value;
16853 tree index = ce->index;
16854 int pos = curpos;
16855 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16856 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
16857 * fieldsize;
16858 else if (index)
16859 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
16861 if (val)
16863 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16864 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16865 return false;
16867 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
16868 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16870 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
16871 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
16872 while (count > 0)
16874 if (val)
16875 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
16876 curpos += fieldsize;
16879 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
16881 return true;
16883 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
16884 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
16886 tree field = NULL_TREE;
16887 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16888 constructor_elt *ce;
16890 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16891 return false;
16893 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
16894 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
16896 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
16898 tree val = ce->value;
16899 int pos, fieldsize;
16901 if (ce->index != 0)
16902 field = ce->index;
16904 if (val)
16905 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16907 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
16908 return false;
16910 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
16911 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
16912 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
16913 return false;
16914 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
16915 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
16916 return false;
16917 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
16918 pos = int_byte_position (field);
16919 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
16920 if (val
16921 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16922 return false;
16924 return true;
16926 return false;
16927 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16928 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
16929 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
16930 default:
16931 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
16935 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
16936 attribute is the const value T. */
16938 static bool
16939 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
16941 tree init;
16942 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
16943 rtx rtl;
16945 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
16946 return false;
16948 init = t;
16949 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
16951 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
16952 if (rtl)
16953 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
16954 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
16955 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
16956 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
16958 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
16959 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
16961 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
16962 ggc_alloc_cleared_atomic (size);
16964 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
16966 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
16967 return true;
16971 return false;
16974 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
16975 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
16976 variable with static storage duration
16977 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
16979 static bool
16980 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
16983 if (!decl
16984 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
16985 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL))
16986 return false;
16988 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
16989 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
16990 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
16991 /* OK */;
16992 else
16993 return false;
16995 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
16996 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
16997 return false;
16999 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
17002 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
17003 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
17004 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
17005 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
17006 expressions. */
17008 static dw_loc_list_ref
17009 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17011 dw_fde_ref fde;
17012 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
17013 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
17014 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
17015 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
17016 dw_cfa_location remember;
17018 fde = current_fde ();
17019 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
17021 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
17022 list_tail = &list;
17023 list = NULL;
17025 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
17026 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
17027 remember = next_cfa;
17029 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
17031 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
17032 advance opcodes. */
17033 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
17034 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17036 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17037 last_label = start_label;
17039 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
17040 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
17042 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
17043 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
17044 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
17045 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
17046 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17048 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17049 start_label, last_label, section);
17051 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17052 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17053 start_label = last_label;
17055 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
17056 break;
17058 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
17059 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
17060 gcc_unreachable ();
17062 default:
17063 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17064 break;
17067 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17069 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17070 start_label, last_label, section);
17071 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17072 start_label = last_label;
17075 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
17076 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
17078 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
17079 gen_llsym (list);
17081 return list;
17084 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
17085 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
17086 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
17087 before the latter is negated. */
17089 static void
17090 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17092 rtx reg, elim;
17094 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
17095 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
17096 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
17097 #else
17098 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
17099 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
17100 #endif
17102 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
17103 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
17105 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
17106 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
17109 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
17110 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
17111 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
17112 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
17113 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
17114 : stack_pointer_rtx));
17116 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
17119 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
17120 the value of the attribute. */
17122 static void
17123 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
17125 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
17127 if (demangle_name_func)
17128 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
17130 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
17134 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
17136 static void
17137 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
17139 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
17140 char *wd1;
17142 if (wd == NULL)
17143 return;
17145 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
17147 int wdlen;
17149 wdlen = strlen (wd);
17150 wd1 = (char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (wdlen + 2);
17151 strcpy (wd1, wd);
17152 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
17153 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
17154 wd = wd1;
17157 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
17160 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
17161 default. */
17163 static int
17164 lower_bound_default (void)
17166 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
17168 case DW_LANG_C:
17169 case DW_LANG_C89:
17170 case DW_LANG_C99:
17171 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
17172 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
17173 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
17174 case DW_LANG_Java:
17175 return 0;
17176 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
17177 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
17178 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
17179 return 1;
17180 case DW_LANG_UPC:
17181 case DW_LANG_D:
17182 case DW_LANG_Python:
17183 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
17184 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
17185 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
17186 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
17187 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
17188 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
17189 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
17190 case DW_LANG_PLI:
17191 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
17192 default:
17193 return -1;
17197 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
17198 a representation for that bound. */
17200 static void
17201 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
17203 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
17205 case ERROR_MARK:
17206 return;
17208 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
17209 case INTEGER_CST:
17211 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
17212 int dflt;
17214 /* Use the default if possible. */
17215 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
17216 && host_integerp (bound, 0)
17217 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
17218 && tree_low_cst (bound, 0) == dflt)
17221 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
17222 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
17223 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
17224 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
17226 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
17227 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
17228 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
17229 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
17231 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
17232 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
17233 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
17234 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
17235 else
17236 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
17237 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
17239 break;
17241 CASE_CONVERT:
17242 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17243 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
17244 break;
17246 case SAVE_EXPR:
17247 break;
17249 case VAR_DECL:
17250 case PARM_DECL:
17251 case RESULT_DECL:
17253 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
17255 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
17256 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
17257 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
17258 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
17259 later parameter. */
17260 if (decl_die != NULL)
17262 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
17263 break;
17266 /* FALLTHRU */
17268 default:
17270 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
17271 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
17273 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
17274 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17276 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
17277 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
17279 /* If DW_AT_*bound is not a reference nor constant, it is
17280 a DWARF expression rather than location description.
17281 For that loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0) is needed.
17282 If that fails to give a single element list,
17283 fall back to outputting this as a reference anyway. */
17284 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
17285 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
17287 add_AT_loc (subrange_die, bound_attr, list2->expr);
17288 break;
17291 if (list == NULL)
17292 break;
17294 if (current_function_decl == 0)
17295 ctx = comp_unit_die ();
17296 else
17297 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
17299 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
17300 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17301 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
17302 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
17303 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
17304 break;
17309 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
17310 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
17311 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
17312 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
17314 static void
17315 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
17317 unsigned dimension_number;
17318 tree lower, upper;
17319 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
17321 for (dimension_number = 0;
17322 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
17323 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
17325 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
17327 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
17328 break;
17330 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
17331 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
17332 here. */
17333 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
17334 if (domain)
17336 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
17337 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
17338 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
17340 /* Define the index type. */
17341 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
17343 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
17344 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
17345 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
17346 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
17347 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
17348 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
17349 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
17351 else
17352 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
17353 type_die);
17356 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
17357 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
17358 dimension arr(N:*)
17359 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
17360 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
17361 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
17363 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
17364 if (upper)
17365 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
17368 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
17369 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
17370 bounds. */
17374 static void
17375 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
17377 unsigned size;
17379 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
17381 case ERROR_MARK:
17382 size = 0;
17383 break;
17384 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
17385 case RECORD_TYPE:
17386 case UNION_TYPE:
17387 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
17388 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
17389 break;
17390 case FIELD_DECL:
17391 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
17392 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
17393 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
17394 even for bit-fields. */
17395 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17396 break;
17397 default:
17398 gcc_unreachable ();
17401 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
17402 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
17403 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
17404 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
17405 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17408 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
17409 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
17410 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
17411 bit-field itself.
17413 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
17414 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
17415 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
17416 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
17417 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
17418 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
17420 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
17421 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
17422 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
17424 static inline void
17425 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17427 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
17428 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
17429 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
17430 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
17431 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
17432 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
17434 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
17435 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
17437 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
17438 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
17439 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
17440 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
17441 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
17442 return;
17444 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
17446 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
17447 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
17448 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
17449 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
17450 below must take account of these differences. */
17451 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
17452 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
17454 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17456 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
17457 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
17460 bit_offset
17461 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
17462 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
17463 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
17465 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
17468 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
17469 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
17471 static inline void
17472 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17474 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
17475 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
17476 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
17478 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
17479 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
17482 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
17483 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
17485 static inline void
17486 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
17488 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
17489 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
17490 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
17493 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
17494 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
17495 equate table. */
17497 static inline dw_die_ref
17498 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
17500 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
17502 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
17504 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
17505 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
17506 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
17508 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
17509 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
17510 tree fn = origin;
17512 if (TYPE_P (fn))
17513 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
17515 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
17516 if (fn)
17517 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
17520 if (DECL_P (origin))
17521 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
17522 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
17523 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
17525 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
17526 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
17527 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
17528 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
17529 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
17530 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
17531 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
17532 here. */
17534 if (origin_die)
17535 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
17536 return origin_die;
17539 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
17541 static inline void
17542 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
17544 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
17546 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
17548 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
17549 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
17550 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
17551 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
17552 0));
17554 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
17555 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
17556 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
17557 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
17558 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
17562 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
17563 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
17564 standardized it. */
17566 static void
17567 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17569 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
17571 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
17572 if (name[0] == '*')
17573 name = &name[1];
17575 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
17576 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
17577 else
17578 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
17581 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
17583 static void
17584 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17586 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17588 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
17589 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17592 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
17594 static void
17595 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17597 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
17598 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
17599 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
17600 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
17601 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
17603 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
17604 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
17606 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
17608 asm_name = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
17609 asm_name->die = die;
17610 asm_name->created_for = decl;
17611 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
17612 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
17614 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
17615 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
17619 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
17620 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
17622 static void
17623 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17625 tree decl_name;
17627 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
17628 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
17630 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
17631 if (name)
17632 add_name_attribute (die, name);
17633 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17634 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
17636 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
17639 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17640 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17641 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17642 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
17644 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
17645 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
17646 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
17648 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
17651 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17652 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
17654 void
17655 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
17657 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17658 dw_die_ref die;
17660 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
17661 die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
17662 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
17663 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
17664 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
17665 current_function_funcdef_no);
17666 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
17668 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
17669 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
17670 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
17672 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
17673 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
17675 else
17677 die->die_sib = die;
17678 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
17681 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
17683 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
17685 static void
17686 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
17688 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
17691 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
17693 static inline void
17694 pop_decl_scope (void)
17696 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
17699 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
17700 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
17701 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
17702 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
17703 the current active scope. */
17705 static dw_die_ref
17706 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
17708 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
17709 tree containing_scope;
17710 int i;
17712 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
17713 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
17715 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
17717 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
17718 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
17720 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
17721 /* OK */;
17722 else
17723 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17726 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
17727 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
17728 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
17729 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
17730 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17732 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
17733 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
17734 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
17736 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
17737 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
17738 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
17739 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
17740 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
17741 break;
17743 if (i < 0)
17745 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
17746 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
17747 /*We are not in the middle of emitting the type
17748 CONTAINING_SCOPE. Let's see if it's emitted already. */
17749 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
17751 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
17752 if (scope_die == NULL)
17753 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
17755 else
17756 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
17758 else
17759 scope_die = context_die;
17761 return scope_die;
17764 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
17766 static inline int
17767 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17769 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
17770 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
17771 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
17772 return 1;
17774 return 0;
17777 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
17779 static inline int
17780 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17782 return (context_die
17783 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
17784 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
17785 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
17786 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
17789 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
17790 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
17792 static inline int
17793 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17795 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
17796 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
17799 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
17800 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
17801 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
17803 static void
17804 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
17805 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
17807 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
17808 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
17810 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
17811 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
17812 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
17813 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
17814 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
17815 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
17816 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
17818 if (code == ERROR_MARK
17819 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
17820 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
17821 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
17822 || code == VOID_TYPE)
17823 return;
17825 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
17826 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
17827 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
17828 context_die);
17830 if (type_die != NULL)
17831 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
17834 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
17835 function call type. */
17836 static void
17837 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
17839 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
17841 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
17842 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17844 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
17845 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
17846 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
17847 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
17848 time being, following existing custom. */
17849 if (is_fortran ()
17850 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
17851 value = DW_CC_program;
17853 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
17854 is not DW_CC_normal. */
17855 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
17856 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
17859 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
17860 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
17861 was declared without a tag. */
17863 static const char *
17864 type_tag (const_tree type)
17866 const char *name = 0;
17868 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
17870 tree t = 0;
17872 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
17873 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
17874 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
17875 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
17877 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
17878 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
17879 involved. */
17880 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
17881 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17883 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
17884 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
17885 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
17886 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
17887 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
17888 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17889 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
17892 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
17893 if (!name && t != 0)
17894 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
17897 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
17900 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
17901 for bit field types. */
17903 static inline tree
17904 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
17906 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
17907 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
17910 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17911 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17913 #if 0
17914 static const char *
17915 decl_start_label (tree decl)
17917 rtx x;
17918 const char *fnname;
17920 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
17921 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
17923 x = XEXP (x, 0);
17924 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
17926 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
17927 return fnname;
17929 #endif
17931 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
17932 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
17933 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
17935 static void
17936 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17938 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
17939 dw_die_ref array_die;
17941 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
17942 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
17943 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
17944 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
17945 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
17946 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
17947 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
17948 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
17949 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
17951 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
17952 tree element_type;
17954 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
17955 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
17956 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
17957 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
17958 && is_fortran ()
17959 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
17961 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
17963 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
17964 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17965 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17966 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17967 if (size >= 0)
17968 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17969 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
17970 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
17971 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
17973 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
17974 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
17976 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
17977 if (loc && size > 0)
17979 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
17980 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
17981 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17984 return;
17987 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types
17988 (e.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10]) unless the inner
17989 array type comes before the outer array type. We thus call gen_type_die
17990 before we new_die and must prevent nested array types collapsing for this
17991 target. */
17993 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17994 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
17995 collapse_nested_arrays = false;
17996 #endif
17998 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
17999 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
18000 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
18002 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
18003 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
18005 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
18006 if (is_fortran ()
18007 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
18008 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
18009 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
18010 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
18012 #if 0
18013 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
18014 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
18015 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
18016 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
18017 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
18018 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
18019 for multidimensional arrays. */
18020 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
18021 #endif
18023 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18024 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
18025 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
18026 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
18027 && ! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
18028 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18029 else
18030 #endif
18031 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
18033 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
18034 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
18035 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node);
18036 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
18037 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1));
18039 else
18040 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
18042 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
18043 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
18044 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
18045 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
18046 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18048 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
18049 break;
18050 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
18053 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18054 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
18055 #endif
18057 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18059 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
18060 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
18063 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18064 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
18066 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
18067 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
18068 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18070 if (val == base_decl)
18071 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
18073 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
18075 CASE_CONVERT:
18076 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
18077 case VAR_DECL:
18078 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
18079 case INTEGER_CST:
18080 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
18081 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
18082 break;
18083 case INDIRECT_REF:
18084 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
18085 if (size < 0)
18086 break;
18087 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
18088 if (!loc)
18089 break;
18090 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18091 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
18092 else
18093 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
18094 return loc;
18095 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
18096 case PLUS_EXPR:
18097 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
18098 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
18099 < 16384)
18101 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
18102 if (!loc)
18103 break;
18104 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
18106 else
18108 op = DW_OP_plus;
18109 do_binop:
18110 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
18111 if (!loc)
18112 break;
18113 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
18114 if (!loc2)
18115 break;
18116 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
18117 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18119 return loc;
18120 case MINUS_EXPR:
18121 op = DW_OP_minus;
18122 goto do_binop;
18123 case MULT_EXPR:
18124 op = DW_OP_mul;
18125 goto do_binop;
18126 case EQ_EXPR:
18127 op = DW_OP_eq;
18128 goto do_binop;
18129 case NE_EXPR:
18130 op = DW_OP_ne;
18131 goto do_binop;
18132 default:
18133 break;
18135 return NULL;
18138 static void
18139 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
18140 tree val, tree base_decl)
18142 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
18144 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
18146 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
18147 return;
18150 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
18151 if (!loc)
18152 return;
18154 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
18157 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
18158 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
18160 static void
18161 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
18162 dw_die_ref context_die)
18164 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18165 dw_die_ref array_die;
18166 int dim;
18168 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
18169 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
18170 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
18172 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
18173 if (is_fortran ()
18174 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
18175 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
18177 if (info->data_location)
18178 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
18179 info->base_decl);
18180 if (info->associated)
18181 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
18182 info->base_decl);
18183 if (info->allocated)
18184 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
18185 info->base_decl);
18187 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
18189 dw_die_ref subrange_die
18190 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
18192 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
18194 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
18195 int dflt;
18197 if (host_integerp (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0)
18198 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
18199 && tree_low_cst (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0) == dflt)
18201 else
18202 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
18203 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
18204 info->base_decl);
18206 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
18207 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
18208 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
18209 info->base_decl);
18210 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
18211 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
18212 info->dimen[dim].stride,
18213 info->base_decl);
18216 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
18217 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18219 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
18220 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
18223 #if 0
18224 static void
18225 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18227 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18228 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
18230 if (origin != NULL)
18231 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
18232 else
18234 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
18235 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18236 0, 0, context_die);
18239 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18240 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
18241 else
18242 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
18244 #endif
18246 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
18247 emit full debugging info for them. */
18249 static void
18250 retry_incomplete_types (void)
18252 int i;
18254 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
18255 if (should_emit_struct_debug (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i),
18256 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
18257 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die ());
18260 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
18262 static enum dwarf_tag
18263 record_type_tag (tree type)
18265 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
18266 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18268 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
18270 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
18271 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18273 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
18274 return DW_TAG_class_type;
18276 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
18277 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18278 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
18279 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18281 default:
18282 gcc_unreachable ();
18286 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
18287 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
18288 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
18289 DIE. */
18291 static dw_die_ref
18292 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18294 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18296 if (type_die == NULL)
18298 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
18299 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18300 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18301 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
18302 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18303 && ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
18304 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
18306 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
18307 return type_die;
18308 else
18309 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18311 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
18312 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
18313 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
18314 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
18316 tree link;
18318 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18319 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
18320 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
18322 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18323 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18326 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
18327 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
18328 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
18329 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
18331 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
18332 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
18334 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
18335 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
18337 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
18338 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
18340 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
18341 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
18343 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
18344 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
18345 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
18346 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
18347 values as if they were signed. That means that
18348 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
18349 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
18350 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
18351 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
18354 else
18355 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18357 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18358 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
18360 return type_die;
18363 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
18364 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
18365 type.
18367 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
18368 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
18369 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
18370 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
18371 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
18372 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
18373 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
18374 argument type of some subprogram type.
18375 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
18376 are emitted. */
18378 static dw_die_ref
18379 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
18380 dw_die_ref context_die)
18382 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
18383 tree ultimate_origin;
18384 dw_die_ref parm_die
18385 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
18387 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
18389 case tcc_declaration:
18390 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
18391 if (node || ultimate_origin)
18392 origin = ultimate_origin;
18393 if (origin != NULL)
18394 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
18395 else if (emit_name_p)
18396 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
18397 if (origin == NULL
18398 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin)
18399 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
18400 decl_function_context
18401 (node_or_origin))))
18403 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
18404 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
18405 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
18406 context_die);
18407 else
18408 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
18409 TREE_READONLY (node_or_origin),
18410 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node_or_origin),
18411 context_die);
18413 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
18414 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18416 if (node && node != origin)
18417 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
18418 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
18419 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
18420 DW_AT_location);
18422 break;
18424 case tcc_type:
18425 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
18426 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
18427 break;
18429 default:
18430 gcc_unreachable ();
18433 return parm_die;
18436 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
18437 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
18438 parameter pack.
18440 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
18441 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
18442 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
18443 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
18444 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
18445 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
18447 static dw_die_ref
18448 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
18449 tree pack_arg,
18450 dw_die_ref subr_die,
18451 tree *next_arg)
18453 tree arg;
18454 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
18456 gcc_assert (parm_pack
18457 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
18458 && subr_die);
18460 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
18461 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
18463 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
18465 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
18466 parm_pack))
18467 break;
18468 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
18469 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
18470 parm_pack_die);
18472 if (next_arg)
18473 *next_arg = arg;
18474 return parm_pack_die;
18477 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
18478 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
18480 static void
18481 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18483 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
18486 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
18487 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
18488 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
18489 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
18491 static void
18492 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18494 tree link;
18495 tree formal_type = NULL;
18496 tree first_parm_type;
18497 tree arg;
18499 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18501 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
18502 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
18504 else
18505 arg = NULL_TREE;
18507 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
18509 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
18510 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
18511 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
18513 dw_die_ref parm_die;
18515 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
18516 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
18517 break;
18519 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
18520 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
18521 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
18522 context_die);
18523 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
18524 && link == first_parm_type)
18526 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18527 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18528 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
18530 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
18531 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18533 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
18534 if (arg)
18535 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
18538 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
18539 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
18540 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
18541 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
18543 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
18544 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
18545 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
18546 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
18547 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
18548 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
18551 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
18552 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
18553 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
18554 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
18555 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
18557 static void
18558 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
18560 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
18562 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
18563 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
18564 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18565 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
18566 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
18568 dw_die_ref type_die;
18569 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
18571 push_decl_scope (type);
18572 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18573 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18574 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
18575 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
18577 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
18578 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
18579 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
18580 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
18581 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
18583 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
18584 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
18587 else
18588 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
18590 pop_decl_scope ();
18594 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
18595 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
18597 static void
18598 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
18600 dw_die_ref old_die;
18601 tree save_fn;
18602 tree context;
18603 int was_abstract;
18604 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
18606 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
18607 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
18609 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18610 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18611 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
18612 return;
18614 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
18615 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
18616 get locations in abstract instantces. */
18617 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
18618 decl_loc_table = NULL;
18620 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
18621 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
18622 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18624 context = decl_class_context (decl);
18625 if (context)
18626 gen_type_die_for_member
18627 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
18630 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
18631 save_fn = current_function_decl;
18632 current_function_decl = decl;
18633 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
18635 was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
18636 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
18637 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
18638 if (! was_abstract)
18639 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
18641 current_function_decl = save_fn;
18642 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
18643 pop_cfun ();
18646 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
18647 htab_traverse.
18649 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18650 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
18652 static int
18653 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18655 tree type;
18656 dw_die_ref die;
18658 type = (tree) *slot;
18659 die = lookup_type_die (type);
18660 if (die != NULL)
18661 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18662 return 1;
18665 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
18666 through htab_traverse.
18668 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18669 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
18670 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
18672 static int
18673 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
18674 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18676 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
18677 dw_die_ref die;
18679 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
18680 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
18681 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
18682 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
18683 if (die)
18685 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
18686 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
18687 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (entry->var_decl);
18688 if (node && node->needed)
18690 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18691 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
18692 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
18693 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18696 return 1;
18699 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
18701 static void
18702 premark_used_types (void)
18704 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
18705 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
18708 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
18710 static void
18711 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
18713 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
18714 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
18715 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
18718 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
18719 block-local). */
18721 static void
18722 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18724 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18725 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18726 dw_die_ref subr_die;
18727 tree fn_arg_types;
18728 tree outer_scope;
18729 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18730 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
18731 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
18733 premark_used_types ();
18735 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
18736 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
18737 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
18738 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
18739 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
18741 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
18742 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
18744 origin = NULL;
18745 gcc_assert (!old_die);
18748 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
18749 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
18750 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
18751 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
18752 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
18753 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18754 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
18756 if (origin != NULL)
18758 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
18760 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
18761 inline function. */
18762 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
18763 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
18765 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18766 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
18768 else if (old_die)
18770 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18771 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
18773 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
18774 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
18775 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
18776 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
18777 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18779 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
18780 something we have already output. */
18781 return;
18784 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
18785 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
18786 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
18787 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
18788 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
18789 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
18790 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
18791 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent) || context_die == NULL)
18792 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
18793 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
18794 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
18795 == (unsigned) s.line))))
18797 subr_die = old_die;
18799 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
18800 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
18801 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
18802 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
18803 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
18804 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18805 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
18806 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
18808 else
18810 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18811 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
18812 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
18813 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
18814 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
18815 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18818 else
18820 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18822 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18823 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18825 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
18826 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18828 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
18829 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18830 0, 0, context_die);
18833 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18834 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18835 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18837 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18840 if (declaration)
18842 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18844 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18846 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
18847 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
18848 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
18849 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18850 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
18852 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
18853 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
18854 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
18855 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
18857 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
18858 later reused to represent definition. */
18859 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18862 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18864 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
18866 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18867 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
18868 else
18869 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
18871 else
18873 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18874 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
18875 else
18876 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
18879 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
18880 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
18881 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18883 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18885 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18887 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
18889 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18890 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18892 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
18894 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
18895 current_function_funcdef_no);
18896 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
18897 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
18898 current_function_funcdef_no);
18899 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
18901 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18902 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
18903 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
18904 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
18905 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
18906 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
18907 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
18908 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
18909 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
18910 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
18911 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
18912 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
18915 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[current_funcdef_fde];
18917 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
18918 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
18919 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
18921 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
18922 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
18923 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
18925 #endif
18927 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18928 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18930 else
18931 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
18932 hot section and one for cold section, then use the hot/cold
18933 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
18935 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
18936 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
18937 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
18938 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
18940 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18941 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18942 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18946 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18947 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
18948 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
18949 #endif
18951 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
18953 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
18954 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
18955 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
18956 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
18957 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
18958 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
18959 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
18960 function. */
18961 if (dwarf_version >= 3)
18963 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
18964 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
18966 else
18968 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
18969 if (list->dw_loc_next)
18970 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
18971 else
18972 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
18975 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
18976 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
18977 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
18978 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
18979 by this displacement. */
18980 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
18982 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
18983 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
18984 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
18987 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18988 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18989 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
18991 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
18992 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
18993 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
18994 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
18995 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
18996 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
18997 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
18998 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
18999 an ellipsis at the end. */
19001 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
19002 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
19003 its formal parameters. */
19004 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19006 else if (declaration)
19007 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
19008 else
19010 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
19011 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
19012 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
19013 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
19014 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
19015 : NULL;
19017 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
19018 emit their relevant DIEs.
19020 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
19021 as well as it being a normal function.
19023 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
19024 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
19025 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
19026 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
19027 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
19028 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
19029 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
19030 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
19031 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
19032 children DIE.
19034 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
19035 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
19037 if (generic_decl_parm
19038 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
19039 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
19040 parm, subr_die,
19041 &parm);
19042 else if (parm)
19044 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
19046 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
19047 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
19048 && parm_die
19049 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19050 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
19052 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
19055 if (generic_decl_parm)
19056 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
19059 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
19060 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
19061 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
19062 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
19063 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
19064 parameters at all. */
19065 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19066 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
19068 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
19069 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19070 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
19072 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19073 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
19076 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
19077 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
19078 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
19080 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
19081 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
19082 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
19083 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
19084 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
19085 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
19086 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
19088 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
19089 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
19090 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
19091 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
19092 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
19093 constructor function. */
19094 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
19096 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
19097 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
19098 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
19100 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
19101 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
19103 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
19104 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
19108 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
19110 static hashval_t
19111 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
19113 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
19114 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
19117 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
19118 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
19120 static int
19121 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
19123 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
19124 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
19125 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
19128 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
19129 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
19131 static void
19132 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19134 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
19135 tree com_decl;
19136 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19137 tree ultimate_origin;
19138 dw_die_ref var_die;
19139 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
19140 dw_die_ref origin_die;
19141 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
19142 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
19143 bool specialization_p = false;
19145 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
19146 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
19147 origin = ultimate_origin;
19148 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
19150 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
19151 of a data member. */
19152 if (com_decl)
19154 dw_die_ref com_die;
19155 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
19156 die_node com_die_arg;
19158 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
19159 if (var_die)
19161 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
19163 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
19164 if (loc)
19166 if (off)
19168 /* Optimize the common case. */
19169 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
19170 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19171 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19172 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
19173 == SYMBOL_REF)
19174 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19175 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
19176 else
19177 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19179 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19180 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19183 return;
19186 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
19187 common_block_die_table
19188 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
19189 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
19191 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19192 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
19193 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
19194 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19195 if (com_die == NULL)
19197 const char *cnam
19198 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
19199 void **slot;
19201 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
19202 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
19203 if (loc)
19205 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19206 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
19207 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
19208 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19210 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19211 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19212 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
19213 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19214 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
19215 *slot = (void *) com_die;
19217 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
19219 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19220 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19221 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19223 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
19224 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19225 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
19226 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
19227 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19228 if (loc)
19230 if (off)
19232 /* Optimize the common case. */
19233 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
19234 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19235 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19236 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
19237 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19238 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
19239 else
19240 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19242 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19244 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19245 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19246 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19247 return;
19250 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
19251 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
19252 DIE for it again. Allow re-declarations of DECLs that are
19253 inside functions, though. */
19254 if (old_die && declaration && !local_scope_p (context_die))
19255 return;
19257 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
19258 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
19259 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
19260 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
19261 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19262 else
19263 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
19265 origin_die = NULL;
19266 if (origin != NULL)
19267 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
19269 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
19270 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
19272 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
19273 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
19274 sharing them.
19276 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
19278 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
19279 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
19280 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
19281 declaration. */
19282 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
19283 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
19285 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
19286 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
19287 specialization_p = true;
19288 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
19290 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19291 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
19293 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
19294 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
19296 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
19297 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
19299 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
19300 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
19303 else
19304 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19306 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19307 || (origin != NULL
19308 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
19309 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
19310 decl_function_context
19311 (decl_or_origin))))
19313 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
19315 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19316 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19317 else
19318 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl_or_origin),
19319 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19322 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19324 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19325 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19327 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19328 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19330 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
19333 if (declaration)
19334 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19336 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration || old_die == NULL))
19337 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19339 if (! declaration
19340 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
19341 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
19342 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
19343 already set. */
19344 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
19345 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19346 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
19347 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
19348 to add it again. */
19349 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
19351 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19352 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
19353 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19354 else
19355 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die,
19356 decl_or_origin,
19357 DW_AT_location);
19358 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19360 else
19361 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
19364 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
19366 static void
19367 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19369 dw_die_ref const_die;
19370 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19372 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
19373 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
19374 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
19375 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19376 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19377 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19378 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19379 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
19382 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
19384 static void
19385 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19387 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19388 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
19389 rtx insn;
19390 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19392 if (origin != NULL)
19393 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
19394 else
19395 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
19397 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
19398 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
19399 else
19401 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19403 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
19404 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
19405 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
19406 if (insn
19407 && (LABEL_P (insn)
19408 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
19409 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
19411 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
19412 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
19413 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
19414 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
19415 it if it ever does happen. */
19416 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
19418 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
19419 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19424 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
19425 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
19426 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
19428 static inline void
19429 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19431 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
19433 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19435 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
19436 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
19441 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
19442 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
19444 static inline void
19445 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19447 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19449 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
19450 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19452 tree chain;
19454 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
19456 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19457 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19458 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
19461 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
19463 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
19466 add_ranges (chain);
19467 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
19469 while (chain);
19470 add_ranges (NULL);
19472 else
19474 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19475 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19476 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19477 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
19478 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19479 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
19483 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
19485 static void
19486 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19488 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
19490 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19491 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
19493 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
19496 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
19498 static void
19499 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19501 tree decl;
19503 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
19504 be abstract. */
19505 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
19507 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
19509 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
19510 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
19511 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
19512 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
19513 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19515 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
19517 dw_die_ref subr_die
19518 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
19520 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
19521 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19522 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19523 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19525 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
19526 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
19530 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
19532 static void
19533 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19535 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19537 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
19538 return;
19540 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19541 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19542 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
19543 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
19544 context_die);
19546 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
19548 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19549 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19550 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19553 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
19554 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19556 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19557 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19559 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19561 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
19562 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19565 #if 0
19566 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19567 Use modified_type_die instead.
19568 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19569 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19571 static void
19572 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19574 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19575 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19577 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19578 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19579 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19582 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19583 Use modified_type_die instead.
19584 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19585 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19587 static void
19588 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19590 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19592 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
19593 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19594 else
19595 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19597 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
19598 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19599 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19601 #endif
19603 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
19605 static void
19606 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19608 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19609 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
19610 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19612 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19613 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
19614 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
19615 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19618 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
19620 static dw_die_ref
19621 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
19623 dw_die_ref die;
19624 char producer[250];
19625 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
19626 int language;
19628 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
19630 if (filename)
19632 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
19633 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
19634 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
19635 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
19638 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
19640 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
19641 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
19642 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
19643 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
19644 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
19645 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
19646 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
19647 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19648 strcat (producer, " -g");
19649 #endif
19651 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
19653 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
19654 from the global list of translation units. */
19655 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
19657 unsigned i;
19658 tree t;
19659 const char *common_lang = NULL;
19661 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (tree, all_translation_units, i, t)
19663 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
19664 continue;
19665 if (!common_lang)
19666 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
19667 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
19669 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
19670 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
19671 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
19672 common_lang = "GNU C++";
19673 else
19675 /* Fall back to C. */
19676 common_lang = NULL;
19677 break;
19681 if (common_lang)
19682 language_string = common_lang;
19685 language = DW_LANG_C89;
19686 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
19687 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
19688 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
19689 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
19690 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
19691 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
19692 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19694 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
19695 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
19696 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
19697 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
19698 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
19699 language = DW_LANG_Java;
19700 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
19701 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
19702 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
19703 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
19706 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
19708 switch (language)
19710 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
19711 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
19712 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
19713 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
19714 lowercases everything. */
19715 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
19716 break;
19717 default:
19718 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
19719 break;
19721 return die;
19724 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
19726 static void
19727 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
19729 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
19731 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
19732 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
19734 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
19735 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
19737 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
19738 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
19739 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
19740 if (access == access_public_node)
19742 if (dwarf_version == 2
19743 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
19744 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
19746 else if (access == access_protected_node)
19747 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
19748 else if (dwarf_version > 2
19749 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
19750 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
19753 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
19755 static void
19756 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19758 tree member;
19759 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
19760 dw_die_ref child;
19762 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
19763 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
19764 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
19765 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
19766 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
19767 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
19768 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
19769 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
19770 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
19771 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
19772 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
19774 /* First output info about the base classes. */
19775 if (binfo)
19777 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
19778 int i;
19779 tree base;
19781 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
19782 gen_inheritance_die (base,
19783 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
19784 : access_public_node), context_die);
19787 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
19788 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19790 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
19791 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
19792 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
19793 do put them in the right order. */
19795 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19796 if (child)
19797 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19798 else
19799 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19802 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
19803 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19805 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
19806 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
19807 continue;
19809 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19810 if (child)
19811 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19812 else
19813 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19817 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
19818 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
19819 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
19821 static void
19822 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
19823 enum debug_info_usage usage)
19825 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19826 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
19827 int nested = 0;
19828 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
19829 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19830 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
19831 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
19832 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
19834 if (type_die && ! complete)
19835 return;
19837 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
19838 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19839 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
19840 nested = 1;
19842 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19844 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
19845 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
19847 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
19849 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
19850 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
19851 scope_die, type);
19852 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19853 if (old_die)
19854 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
19855 else
19856 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
19858 else
19859 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19861 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
19862 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
19863 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
19864 gen_generic_params_dies (type);
19866 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
19867 then give a list of members. */
19868 if (complete && !ns_decl)
19870 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
19871 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
19872 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19873 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
19874 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
19876 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19877 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19880 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
19881 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
19882 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
19883 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
19885 push_decl_scope (type);
19886 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
19887 pop_decl_scope ();
19889 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
19890 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
19892 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
19894 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
19895 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
19896 lookup_type_die (vtype));
19899 else
19901 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19903 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
19904 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19905 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
19906 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
19909 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
19910 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
19913 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
19915 static void
19916 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19918 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
19919 dw_die_ref subr_die
19920 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
19921 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19923 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
19924 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
19925 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
19926 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
19928 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
19929 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
19932 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
19934 static void
19935 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19937 dw_die_ref type_die;
19938 tree origin;
19940 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
19941 return;
19943 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
19944 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
19945 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19946 if (origin != NULL)
19947 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
19948 else
19950 tree type;
19952 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
19953 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
19955 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
19957 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
19958 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
19960 else
19962 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19964 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19966 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
19967 an anonymous type, e.g:
19968 typedef struct {...} foo;
19969 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
19970 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
19971 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
19972 the C++ FE.
19974 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
19975 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
19976 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
19977 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
19978 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
19979 anonymous struct DIE. */
19980 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
19981 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
19985 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
19986 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
19988 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
19989 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
19990 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
19991 created. */
19992 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19994 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
19997 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
19998 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
20000 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
20001 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
20004 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
20006 static void
20007 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
20008 dw_die_ref context_die,
20009 enum debug_info_usage usage)
20011 int need_pop;
20013 if (type == NULL_TREE
20014 || !is_tagged_type (type))
20015 return;
20017 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
20018 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
20019 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
20020 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
20021 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
20022 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
20023 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
20024 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
20025 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
20027 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
20029 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20030 return;
20032 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
20033 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20034 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20035 need_pop = 1;
20037 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
20038 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
20040 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
20041 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
20042 decls_for_scope. */
20043 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20044 need_pop = 0;
20046 else
20048 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
20049 need_pop = 0;
20052 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
20054 /* This might have been written out by the call to
20055 declare_in_namespace. */
20056 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20057 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
20059 else
20060 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
20062 if (need_pop)
20063 pop_decl_scope ();
20065 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
20066 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
20067 when appropriate. */
20070 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
20072 static void
20073 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
20074 enum debug_info_usage usage)
20076 struct array_descr_info info;
20078 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
20079 return;
20081 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
20082 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
20083 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
20085 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20086 return;
20088 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
20089 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
20091 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
20092 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
20093 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
20094 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20095 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
20097 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20099 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
20100 return;
20103 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
20104 generate debug info for the typedef. */
20105 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20107 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
20108 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
20109 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
20110 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20111 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
20113 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
20114 return;
20117 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
20118 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
20119 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
20120 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
20121 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20123 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
20124 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20125 return;
20128 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
20129 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
20130 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
20131 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
20132 cloned type itself). */
20133 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
20134 type = type_main_variant (type);
20136 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20137 return;
20139 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
20141 case ERROR_MARK:
20142 break;
20144 case POINTER_TYPE:
20145 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
20146 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
20147 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
20148 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
20149 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
20150 statement. */
20151 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20153 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
20154 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
20155 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20156 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20157 break;
20159 case OFFSET_TYPE:
20160 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
20161 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
20162 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
20163 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20165 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
20166 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20167 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20169 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
20170 itself. */
20171 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
20172 break;
20174 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
20175 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
20176 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20177 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20178 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
20179 break;
20181 case METHOD_TYPE:
20182 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
20183 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20184 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20185 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
20186 break;
20188 case ARRAY_TYPE:
20189 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
20190 break;
20192 case VECTOR_TYPE:
20193 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
20194 break;
20196 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20197 case RECORD_TYPE:
20198 case UNION_TYPE:
20199 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20200 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
20201 return;
20203 case VOID_TYPE:
20204 case INTEGER_TYPE:
20205 case REAL_TYPE:
20206 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
20207 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
20208 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
20209 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
20210 break;
20212 case LANG_TYPE:
20213 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
20215 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20216 if (type_die == NULL)
20218 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
20219 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
20220 name = DECL_NAME (name);
20221 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
20222 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20223 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
20226 break;
20228 default:
20229 gcc_unreachable ();
20232 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20235 static void
20236 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20238 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20241 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
20242 things which are local to the given block. */
20244 static void
20245 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
20247 int must_output_die = 0;
20248 bool inlined_func;
20250 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
20251 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20252 return;
20254 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
20256 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
20257 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
20258 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
20259 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
20261 tree sub;
20263 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
20264 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
20266 return;
20269 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
20270 block. */
20271 if (inlined_func)
20272 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
20273 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
20274 must_output_die = 1;
20275 else
20277 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
20278 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
20279 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20280 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
20281 as being a "significant" one. */
20282 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
20283 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
20284 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
20285 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20286 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
20287 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
20288 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20289 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20290 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
20291 must_output_die = 1;
20294 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
20295 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
20296 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
20297 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
20298 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
20299 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
20300 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
20301 if (must_output_die)
20303 if (inlined_func)
20305 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
20306 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
20307 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
20308 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
20309 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
20310 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
20311 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
20312 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
20314 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
20315 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
20316 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
20317 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
20318 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20319 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
20321 else
20322 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
20324 else
20325 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
20328 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
20329 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
20330 static void
20331 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20333 dw_die_ref die;
20334 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20336 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
20337 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
20338 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
20339 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
20340 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
20341 else
20342 die = NULL;
20344 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
20345 add_child_die (context_die, die);
20346 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
20347 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
20348 stmt, context_die);
20349 else
20350 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
20353 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
20354 all of its sub-blocks. */
20356 static void
20357 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
20359 tree decl;
20360 unsigned int i;
20361 tree subblocks;
20363 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
20364 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20365 return;
20367 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
20368 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
20369 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
20370 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
20371 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
20372 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
20373 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
20374 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
20375 context_die);
20377 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
20378 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20379 return;
20381 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
20382 therein) of this block. */
20383 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
20384 subblocks != NULL;
20385 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
20386 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
20389 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
20391 static inline int
20392 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
20394 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
20395 return 1;
20397 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20398 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
20399 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20400 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
20401 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
20402 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
20403 return 1;
20405 return 0;
20408 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
20409 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
20410 constructs like:
20412 typedef struct {...} foo;
20414 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
20415 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
20416 struct type. */
20418 static bool
20419 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
20421 if (decl == NULL_TREE
20422 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
20423 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20424 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
20425 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
20426 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
20427 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
20428 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
20429 || !is_cxx ())
20430 return FALSE;
20432 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
20433 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
20434 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20435 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
20438 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
20440 static inline dw_die_ref
20441 get_context_die (tree context)
20443 if (context)
20445 /* Find die that represents this context. */
20446 if (TYPE_P (context))
20447 return force_type_die (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context));
20448 else
20449 return force_decl_die (context);
20451 return comp_unit_die ();
20454 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
20456 static dw_die_ref
20457 force_decl_die (tree decl)
20459 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20460 unsigned saved_external_flag;
20461 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
20462 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20463 if (!decl_die)
20465 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
20467 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20468 if (decl_die)
20469 return decl_die;
20471 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
20473 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20474 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
20475 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
20476 declaration die. */
20477 save_fn = current_function_decl;
20478 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
20479 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20480 current_function_decl = save_fn;
20481 break;
20483 case VAR_DECL:
20484 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
20485 gen_decl_die() call. */
20486 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
20487 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
20488 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
20489 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
20490 break;
20492 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20493 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20494 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20495 else
20496 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
20497 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
20498 break;
20500 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
20501 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
20502 break;
20504 default:
20505 gcc_unreachable ();
20508 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
20509 if (!decl_die)
20510 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20511 gcc_assert (decl_die);
20514 return decl_die;
20517 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
20518 always returned. */
20520 static dw_die_ref
20521 force_type_die (tree type)
20523 dw_die_ref type_die;
20525 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20526 if (!type_die)
20528 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20530 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
20531 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
20532 gcc_assert (type_die);
20534 return type_die;
20537 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
20538 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
20540 static dw_die_ref
20541 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20543 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
20544 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
20545 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20546 /* Force out the namespace. */
20547 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
20549 return context_die;
20552 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
20553 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
20555 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
20556 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
20558 static dw_die_ref
20559 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20561 dw_die_ref ns_context;
20563 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20564 return context_die;
20566 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
20567 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
20568 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
20569 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
20570 return context_die;
20572 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
20574 if (ns_context != context_die)
20576 if (is_fortran ())
20577 return ns_context;
20578 if (DECL_P (thing))
20579 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
20580 else
20581 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
20583 return context_die;
20586 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
20588 static void
20589 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20591 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
20593 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
20594 they are an alias of. */
20595 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
20597 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
20598 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
20599 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
20600 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
20601 context_die, decl);
20602 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
20603 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20605 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20606 if (name)
20607 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
20609 else
20610 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20611 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20612 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20613 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20615 else
20617 /* Output a namespace alias. */
20619 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
20620 dw_die_ref origin_die
20621 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20623 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
20624 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20625 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
20626 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
20627 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
20628 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20629 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
20630 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20634 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
20635 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
20636 for all other decls it returns NULL. */
20638 static dw_die_ref
20639 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20641 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20642 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
20644 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
20645 return NULL;
20647 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
20649 case ERROR_MARK:
20650 break;
20652 case CONST_DECL:
20653 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
20655 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
20656 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
20657 break;
20660 /* Emit its type. */
20661 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20663 /* And its containing namespace. */
20664 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20666 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
20667 break;
20669 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20670 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
20671 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
20672 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
20673 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
20674 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
20675 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
20676 break;
20678 #if 0
20679 /* FIXME */
20680 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
20681 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
20682 if (current_function_decl != decl)
20683 /* This is only a declaration. */;
20684 #endif
20686 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
20687 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
20688 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
20689 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
20690 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20692 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
20693 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
20694 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
20695 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
20696 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20697 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
20698 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
20699 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
20700 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20702 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
20703 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
20706 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
20707 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20709 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
20710 have its containing type. */
20711 if (!origin)
20712 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
20713 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
20714 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
20716 /* And its return type. */
20717 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
20719 /* And its virtual context. */
20720 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20721 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
20723 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
20724 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
20725 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
20727 /* And its containing namespace. */
20728 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20731 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
20732 if (decl)
20733 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20734 break;
20736 case TYPE_DECL:
20737 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20738 actual typedefs. */
20739 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20740 break;
20742 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
20743 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
20744 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
20745 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
20746 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
20747 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
20748 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
20749 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
20750 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
20751 case. */
20752 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20753 break;
20755 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
20756 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20757 else
20758 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
20759 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
20760 break;
20762 case LABEL_DECL:
20763 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
20764 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
20765 break;
20767 case VAR_DECL:
20768 case RESULT_DECL:
20769 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20770 variable declarations or definitions. */
20771 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20772 break;
20774 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
20775 object. */
20776 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
20777 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
20778 else
20779 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
20781 /* And its containing type. */
20782 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
20783 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
20784 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
20786 /* And its containing namespace. */
20787 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
20789 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
20790 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
20791 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
20792 function. */
20793 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
20794 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
20795 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
20796 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
20797 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
20798 context_die);
20799 else
20800 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
20801 break;
20803 case FIELD_DECL:
20804 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
20805 anonymous unions and structs. */
20806 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
20807 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
20808 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
20810 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
20811 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
20813 break;
20815 case PARM_DECL:
20816 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
20817 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
20818 else
20819 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
20820 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
20821 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
20822 context_die);
20824 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20825 case IMPORTED_DECL:
20826 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20827 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
20828 break;
20830 default:
20831 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
20832 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
20833 break;
20836 return NULL;
20839 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
20840 compilation proper has finished. */
20842 static void
20843 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
20845 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
20846 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
20847 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
20848 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
20849 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
20850 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20853 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
20854 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
20855 static void
20856 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
20858 if (!local)
20859 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20862 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
20863 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
20864 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
20865 that DECL belongs to.
20866 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
20867 static void
20868 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
20869 tree name,
20870 tree lexical_block,
20871 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
20873 expanded_location xloc;
20874 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
20875 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
20877 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
20879 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20880 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
20881 gcc_assert (decl);
20883 else
20884 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
20886 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
20888 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
20889 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
20890 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
20891 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
20892 if (!at_import_die)
20894 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
20895 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
20896 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
20897 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
20900 else
20902 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20903 if (!at_import_die)
20905 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
20906 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
20907 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
20909 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
20911 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
20912 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
20913 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
20914 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
20915 return;
20916 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
20917 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
20919 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
20923 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20925 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20926 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
20927 lexical_block_die,
20928 lexical_block);
20929 else
20930 return;
20932 else
20933 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
20934 lexical_block_die,
20935 lexical_block);
20937 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
20938 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
20939 if (name)
20940 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
20941 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20942 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
20945 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
20946 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
20947 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
20948 importing whole module. */
20950 static void
20951 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
20952 bool child)
20954 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
20955 dw_die_ref scope_die;
20957 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20958 return;
20960 gcc_assert (decl);
20962 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
20963 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
20964 itself. */
20966 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
20967 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
20968 if (context
20969 && TYPE_P (context)
20970 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
20971 return;
20973 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20974 return;
20976 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
20978 if (child)
20980 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
20981 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
20982 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
20983 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
20986 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
20987 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
20991 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
20993 void
20994 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
20996 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
20998 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
21000 case ERROR_MARK:
21001 return;
21003 case FUNCTION_DECL:
21004 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
21005 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
21006 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
21007 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
21008 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
21009 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
21010 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
21011 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
21012 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
21013 with the definition of the function.
21015 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
21016 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
21017 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
21018 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
21019 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
21020 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
21021 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
21022 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
21023 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
21024 that they *are* definitions).
21026 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
21027 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
21028 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
21029 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
21030 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
21031 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
21032 return;
21034 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
21035 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
21036 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
21037 if (decl_function_context (decl)
21038 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
21039 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21040 context_die = NULL;
21041 break;
21043 case VAR_DECL:
21044 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
21045 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
21046 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
21047 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
21048 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
21049 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
21050 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
21051 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
21052 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
21053 return;
21055 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
21056 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
21057 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
21059 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
21060 variable declarations or definitions. */
21061 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21062 return;
21063 break;
21065 case CONST_DECL:
21066 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21067 return;
21068 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
21069 return;
21070 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
21071 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
21072 break;
21074 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
21075 case IMPORTED_DECL:
21076 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21077 return;
21078 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
21079 return;
21080 break;
21082 case TYPE_DECL:
21083 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
21084 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
21085 return;
21087 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
21088 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
21089 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
21090 return;
21092 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
21093 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21094 return;
21096 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
21097 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
21098 if (decl_function_context (decl))
21099 context_die = NULL;
21101 break;
21103 default:
21104 return;
21107 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
21110 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
21112 static void
21113 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
21115 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
21117 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
21120 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
21121 a lexical block. */
21123 static void
21124 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21125 unsigned int blocknum)
21127 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21128 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
21131 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
21132 lexical block. */
21134 static void
21135 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
21137 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21138 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
21141 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
21142 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
21144 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
21145 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
21146 we may end up calling them anyway. */
21148 static bool
21149 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
21151 tree decl;
21152 unsigned int i;
21154 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
21155 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
21156 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
21157 return 0;
21158 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
21160 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
21161 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
21162 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
21163 return 0;
21166 return 1;
21169 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
21171 static int
21172 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
21174 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
21175 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
21176 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
21177 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
21180 static hashval_t
21181 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
21183 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
21184 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
21187 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
21188 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
21189 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
21190 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
21191 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
21192 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
21193 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
21194 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
21195 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
21196 all searches. */
21198 static struct dwarf_file_data *
21199 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
21201 void ** slot;
21202 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
21204 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
21205 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
21206 if (file_table_last_lookup
21207 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
21208 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
21209 return file_table_last_lookup;
21211 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
21212 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
21213 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
21214 if (*slot)
21215 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
21217 created = ggc_alloc_dwarf_file_data ();
21218 created->filename = file_name;
21219 created->emitted_number = 0;
21220 *slot = created;
21221 return created;
21224 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
21225 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
21226 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
21227 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
21228 types, which may include filenames. */
21230 static int
21231 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
21233 if (! fd->emitted_number)
21235 if (last_emitted_file)
21236 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
21237 else
21238 fd->emitted_number = 1;
21239 last_emitted_file = fd;
21241 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21243 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
21244 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
21245 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
21246 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
21250 return fd->emitted_number;
21253 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
21254 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
21255 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
21257 static void
21258 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
21260 die_arg_entry entry;
21262 if (!die || !arg)
21263 return;
21265 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21266 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
21267 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
21269 entry.die = die;
21270 entry.arg = arg;
21271 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
21272 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
21273 &entry);
21276 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
21277 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
21278 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
21280 static void
21281 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
21283 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21285 unsigned i;
21286 die_arg_entry *e;
21288 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
21289 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
21294 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
21296 static void
21297 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
21299 dw_die_ref die;
21300 dw_attr_ref attr;
21301 const char *dname;
21303 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
21304 if (!die)
21305 return;
21307 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
21308 if (!dname)
21309 return;
21311 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
21312 if (attr)
21314 struct indirect_string_node *node;
21316 node = find_AT_string (dname);
21317 /* replace the string. */
21318 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
21321 else
21322 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
21325 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a direct function call.
21326 Make an entry into the direct call table, recording the point of call
21327 and a reference to the target function's debug entry. */
21329 static void
21330 dwarf2out_direct_call (tree targ)
21332 dcall_entry e;
21333 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (targ);
21335 /* If this is a clone, use the abstract origin as the target. */
21336 if (origin)
21337 targ = origin;
21339 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
21340 e.poc_decl = current_function_decl;
21341 e.targ_die = force_decl_die (targ);
21342 VEC_safe_push (dcall_entry, gc, dcall_table, &e);
21344 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
21345 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
21348 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a struct vcall_insn). */
21350 static hashval_t
21351 vcall_insn_table_hash (const void *x)
21353 return (hashval_t) ((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid;
21356 /* Return nonzero if insn_uid of struct vcall_insn *X is the same as
21357 insnd_uid of *Y. */
21359 static int
21360 vcall_insn_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
21362 return (((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid
21363 == ((const struct vcall_insn *) y)->insn_uid);
21366 /* Associate VTABLE_SLOT with INSN_UID in the VCALL_INSN_TABLE. */
21368 static void
21369 store_vcall_insn (unsigned int vtable_slot, int insn_uid)
21371 struct vcall_insn *item = ggc_alloc_vcall_insn ();
21372 struct vcall_insn **slot;
21374 gcc_assert (item);
21375 item->insn_uid = insn_uid;
21376 item->vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
21377 slot = (struct vcall_insn **)
21378 htab_find_slot_with_hash (vcall_insn_table, &item,
21379 (hashval_t) insn_uid, INSERT);
21380 *slot = item;
21383 /* Return the VTABLE_SLOT associated with INSN_UID. */
21385 static unsigned int
21386 lookup_vcall_insn (unsigned int insn_uid)
21388 struct vcall_insn item;
21389 struct vcall_insn *p;
21391 item.insn_uid = insn_uid;
21392 item.vtable_slot = 0;
21393 p = (struct vcall_insn *) htab_find_with_hash (vcall_insn_table,
21394 (void *) &item,
21395 (hashval_t) insn_uid);
21396 if (p == NULL)
21397 return (unsigned int) -1;
21398 return p->vtable_slot;
21402 /* Called when lowering indirect calls to RTL. We make a note of INSN_UID
21403 and the OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN from ADDR. For C++ virtual calls, the token
21404 is the vtable slot index that we will need to put in the virtual call
21405 table later. */
21407 static void
21408 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree addr, int insn_uid)
21410 if (is_cxx() && TREE_CODE (addr) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
21412 tree token = OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (addr);
21413 if (TREE_CODE (token) == INTEGER_CST)
21414 store_vcall_insn (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (token), insn_uid);
21418 /* Called when scheduling RTL, when a CALL_INSN is split. Copies the
21419 OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN previously associated with OLD_INSN and associates it
21420 with NEW_INSN. */
21422 static void
21423 dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx old_insn, rtx new_insn)
21425 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (INSN_UID (old_insn));
21427 if (vtable_slot != (unsigned int) -1)
21428 store_vcall_insn (vtable_slot, INSN_UID (new_insn));
21431 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a virtual function call.
21432 Make an entry into the virtual call table, recording the point of call
21433 and the slot index of the vtable entry used to call the virtual member
21434 function. The slot index was associated with the INSN_UID during the
21435 lowering to RTL. */
21437 static void
21438 dwarf2out_virtual_call (int insn_uid)
21440 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (insn_uid);
21441 vcall_entry e;
21443 if (vtable_slot == (unsigned int) -1)
21444 return;
21446 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
21447 e.vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
21448 VEC_safe_push (vcall_entry, gc, vcall_table, &e);
21450 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
21451 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
21454 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
21455 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
21456 our lookup table. */
21458 static void
21459 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
21461 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
21462 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
21463 rtx next_real;
21464 static const char *last_label;
21465 static const char *last_postcall_label;
21466 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
21467 tree decl;
21469 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
21470 return;
21472 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
21473 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
21474 don't do anything. */
21475 if (next_real == NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21476 return;
21478 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
21479 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
21480 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
21481 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
21482 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
21483 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
21485 last_label = NULL;
21486 last_postcall_label = NULL;
21489 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
21490 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
21491 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
21492 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
21493 if (newloc == NULL)
21494 return;
21496 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
21497 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
21498 create a new label and emit it. */
21499 if (last_label == NULL)
21501 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21502 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21503 loclabel_num++;
21504 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21507 if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21508 newloc->label = last_label;
21509 else
21511 if (!last_postcall_label)
21513 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
21514 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21516 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
21519 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
21520 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
21523 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
21524 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
21525 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
21526 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
21528 static void
21529 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
21531 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
21532 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
21534 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
21537 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
21538 and record information relating to this source line, in
21539 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
21541 static void
21542 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
21543 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
21545 static bool last_is_stmt = true;
21547 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
21548 && line != 0)
21550 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
21552 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21554 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
21555 if (flag_debug_asm)
21556 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
21557 filename, line);
21559 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21561 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
21562 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0", file_num, line);
21563 if (is_stmt != last_is_stmt)
21565 fprintf (asm_out_file, " is_stmt %d", is_stmt ? 1 : 0);
21566 last_is_stmt = is_stmt;
21568 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
21569 fprintf (asm_out_file, " discriminator %d", discriminator);
21570 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
21572 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
21573 line_info_table_in_use++;
21575 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
21577 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
21578 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
21579 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
21580 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
21582 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
21583 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
21584 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
21586 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21587 separate_line_info_table
21588 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_separate_line_info_entry,
21589 separate_line_info_table,
21590 separate_line_info_table_allocated);
21591 memset (separate_line_info_table
21592 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
21594 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
21595 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
21598 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
21599 line_info
21600 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
21601 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
21602 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
21603 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
21605 else
21607 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
21609 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
21610 line_info_table_in_use);
21612 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
21613 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
21615 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21616 line_info_table
21617 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_line_info_entry, line_info_table,
21618 line_info_table_allocated);
21619 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
21620 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
21623 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
21624 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
21625 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
21626 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
21631 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
21633 static void
21634 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
21636 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21638 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
21639 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
21641 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
21642 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
21645 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21647 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
21649 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21650 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
21651 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
21652 lineno);
21654 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
21658 /* Record the end of a source file. */
21660 static void
21661 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21663 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21664 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
21665 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
21667 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21669 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
21674 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
21675 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
21676 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
21678 static void
21679 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21680 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21682 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21684 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21685 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
21686 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
21687 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
21691 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
21692 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
21693 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
21695 static void
21696 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21697 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21699 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21701 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21702 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
21703 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
21704 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
21708 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
21710 static void
21711 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21713 /* Allocate the file_table. */
21714 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
21715 file_table_eq, NULL);
21717 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
21718 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
21719 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
21721 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
21722 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
21723 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
21725 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
21726 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
21728 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
21729 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_die_ref
21730 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
21731 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21732 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
21733 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
21735 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
21736 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_line_info_entry
21737 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT);
21738 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21740 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
21741 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
21743 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
21744 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
21745 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
21747 /* Allocate the table that maps insn UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
21748 vcall_insn_table = htab_create_ggc (10, vcall_insn_table_hash,
21749 vcall_insn_table_eq, NULL);
21751 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
21753 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
21755 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
21756 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21757 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
21758 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21759 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
21760 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21761 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
21762 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21763 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
21764 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21765 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
21766 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21767 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
21768 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21769 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
21770 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21771 debug_dcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION,
21772 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21773 debug_vcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION,
21774 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21775 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
21776 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
21777 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
21778 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21779 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
21780 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21782 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
21783 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
21784 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21785 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21786 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
21787 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21788 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
21790 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
21791 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21792 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
21793 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21794 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
21795 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21796 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
21797 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
21798 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
21799 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
21800 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
21801 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
21803 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21805 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21806 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
21807 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21808 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
21811 switch_to_section (text_section);
21812 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
21813 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21815 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
21816 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
21817 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
21822 /* Called before cgraph_optimize starts outputtting functions, variables
21823 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
21825 static void
21826 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
21828 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
21829 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
21830 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
21831 || targetm.except_unwind_info () != UI_DWARF2))
21832 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
21835 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
21836 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
21838 static int
21839 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21841 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
21843 if (node->label && node->refcount)
21845 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
21846 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
21847 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
21850 return 1;
21853 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
21854 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
21856 static void
21857 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
21859 dw_die_ref c;
21861 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
21862 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
21864 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
21866 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
21867 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
21869 static void
21870 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
21872 dw_die_ref c;
21874 if (die->die_mark)
21875 die->die_mark = 0;
21876 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
21879 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
21880 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
21882 static void
21883 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
21885 dw_attr_ref a;
21886 unsigned ix;
21888 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
21890 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
21892 /* A reference to another DIE.
21893 Make sure that it will get emitted.
21894 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
21895 if (dwarf_version < 4
21896 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
21897 || a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die->die_id.die_type_node == NULL)
21898 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
21900 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
21901 accounts properly for it. */
21902 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
21903 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
21908 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
21909 to DIE's children. */
21911 static void
21912 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
21914 dw_die_ref c;
21916 if (die->die_mark == 0)
21918 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
21919 die->die_mark = 1;
21921 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
21922 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
21923 if (die->die_parent)
21924 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
21926 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
21927 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
21929 /* If this node is a specification,
21930 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
21931 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
21932 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
21935 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
21937 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
21938 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
21939 die->die_mark = 2;
21941 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
21942 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
21943 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
21944 for all type definitions. */
21945 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
21946 || (dwarf_version >= 4
21947 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
21948 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
21949 else
21950 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
21954 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
21955 and if so, mark them. */
21957 static void
21958 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
21960 dw_die_ref c;
21962 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21963 return;
21965 switch (die->die_tag)
21967 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
21968 case DW_TAG_union_type:
21969 case DW_TAG_class_type:
21970 break;
21972 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
21973 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
21974 || die->die_definition != NULL)
21975 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
21976 return;
21978 default:
21979 return;
21982 /* Mark children. */
21983 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
21986 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
21988 static void
21989 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
21991 dw_die_ref c;
21993 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
21994 children have been marked as well. */
21995 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21996 return;
21998 switch (die->die_tag)
22000 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
22001 case DW_TAG_union_type:
22002 case DW_TAG_class_type:
22003 if (die->die_perennial_p)
22004 break;
22006 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
22007 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
22008 break;
22010 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
22011 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
22012 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
22013 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
22014 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
22015 if (c)
22016 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
22018 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
22019 return;
22021 case DW_TAG_const_type:
22022 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
22023 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
22024 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
22025 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
22026 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
22027 case DW_TAG_typedef:
22028 case DW_TAG_array_type:
22029 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
22030 case DW_TAG_friend:
22031 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
22032 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
22033 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
22034 case DW_TAG_string_type:
22035 case DW_TAG_set_type:
22036 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
22037 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
22038 case DW_TAG_file_type:
22039 if (die->die_perennial_p)
22040 break;
22042 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
22043 return;
22045 default:
22046 /* Mark everything else. */
22047 break;
22050 if (die->die_mark == 0)
22052 die->die_mark = 1;
22054 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
22055 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
22058 die->die_mark = 2;
22060 /* Mark children. */
22061 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
22064 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
22065 attributes. */
22067 static void
22068 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
22070 dw_attr_ref a;
22071 unsigned ix;
22073 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
22074 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
22076 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
22077 s->refcount++;
22078 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
22079 twice in the hash table. */
22080 if (s->refcount
22081 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
22083 void ** slot;
22084 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
22085 htab_hash_string (s->str),
22086 INSERT);
22087 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
22088 *slot = s;
22093 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
22095 static void
22096 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
22098 dw_die_ref c;
22100 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
22101 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
22103 if (! die->die_child)
22104 return;
22106 c = die->die_child;
22107 do {
22108 dw_die_ref prev = c;
22109 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
22110 if (c == die->die_child)
22112 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
22113 if (prev == c)
22114 /* No marked children at all. */
22115 die->die_child = NULL;
22116 else
22118 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
22119 die->die_child = prev;
22121 return;
22124 if (c != prev->die_sib)
22125 prev->die_sib = c;
22126 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
22127 } while (c != die->die_child);
22130 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
22131 htab_traverse. Clear .debug_str strings that we haven't already
22132 decided to emit. */
22134 static int
22135 prune_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22137 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
22139 if (!node->label || !node->refcount)
22140 htab_clear_slot (debug_str_hash, h);
22142 return 1;
22145 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
22147 static void
22148 prune_unused_types (void)
22150 unsigned int i;
22151 limbo_die_node *node;
22152 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
22153 pubname_ref pub;
22154 dcall_entry *dcall;
22156 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
22157 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
22158 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
22159 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22160 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
22161 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22162 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
22163 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
22165 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
22166 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
22168 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
22169 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
22170 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22171 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
22172 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22174 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
22175 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
22178 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
22179 pubname_table or arange_table. */
22180 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub)
22181 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
22182 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
22183 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
22185 /* Mark nodes referenced from the direct call table. */
22186 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, dcall)
22187 prune_unused_types_mark (dcall->targ_die, 1);
22189 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
22190 if (debug_str_hash && debug_str_hash_forced)
22191 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, prune_indirect_string, NULL);
22192 else if (debug_str_hash)
22193 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
22194 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
22195 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22196 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
22197 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22198 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
22200 /* Leave the marks clear. */
22201 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
22202 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22203 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
22204 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22205 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
22208 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
22209 the file table. */
22210 static int
22211 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
22213 bool *p = (bool *) param;
22214 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
22215 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
22217 *p = true;
22218 return 0;
22220 return 1;
22223 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
22225 static hashval_t
22226 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
22228 hashval_t h;
22229 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
22231 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
22232 return h;
22235 static int
22236 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
22238 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
22239 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
22241 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
22242 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
22245 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
22246 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
22247 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
22248 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
22249 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
22250 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
22252 static inline void
22253 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
22255 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
22256 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
22258 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
22259 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
22261 while (--ix > 0)
22263 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
22265 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
22266 break;
22269 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
22271 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
22272 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
22276 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
22277 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
22278 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
22280 static int
22281 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22283 rtx rtl = *addr;
22285 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
22287 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
22288 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
22289 tree tlen = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, len - 1);
22290 TREE_TYPE (t)
22291 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
22292 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
22293 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
22294 return 1;
22295 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
22296 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
22297 *addr = rtl;
22298 return 0;
22301 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
22302 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
22303 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
22304 return 1;
22306 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
22307 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
22308 return 1;
22310 return 0;
22313 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
22314 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
22315 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
22317 static bool
22318 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
22320 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
22321 if (((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr || loc->dtprel)
22322 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
22323 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_implicit_value
22324 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
22325 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL)))
22326 return false;
22327 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
22328 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
22330 dw_die_ref ref
22331 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
22332 if (ref == NULL)
22333 return false;
22334 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
22335 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
22336 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
22338 return true;
22341 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
22342 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
22343 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
22344 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
22345 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
22346 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
22348 static void
22349 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
22351 dw_die_ref c;
22352 dw_attr_ref a;
22353 dw_loc_list_ref *curr;
22354 unsigned ix;
22356 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
22357 switch (AT_class (a))
22359 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
22360 curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
22361 while (*curr)
22363 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
22365 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
22366 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
22368 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
22369 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
22371 *curr = next;
22373 else
22374 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
22376 if (!AT_loc_list (a))
22378 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22379 ix--;
22381 break;
22382 case dw_val_class_loc:
22383 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (AT_loc (a)))
22385 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22386 ix--;
22388 break;
22389 case dw_val_class_addr:
22390 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
22391 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
22393 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22394 ix--;
22396 break;
22397 default:
22398 break;
22401 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
22404 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
22405 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
22407 static void
22408 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
22410 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
22411 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
22412 htab_t comdat_type_table;
22413 dw_die_ref die = 0;
22414 unsigned int i;
22416 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
22418 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
22419 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
22420 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
22421 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
22422 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
22423 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
22425 bool p = false;
22426 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
22427 if (p)
22428 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
22431 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
22433 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
22434 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
22435 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
22436 DW_AT_location);
22439 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
22440 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
22441 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
22442 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
22443 instance. */
22444 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
22446 next_node = node->next;
22447 die = node->die;
22449 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
22451 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
22453 if (origin)
22454 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
22455 else if (is_cu_die (die))
22457 else if (seen_error ())
22458 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
22459 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
22460 else
22462 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
22463 nested function can be optimized away, which results
22464 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
22465 with the return type of that nested function. Force
22466 this to be a child of the containing function.
22468 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
22469 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
22470 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
22471 the function is likely unreachable too. */
22472 tree context = NULL_TREE;
22474 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
22476 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
22477 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
22478 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
22479 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
22481 gcc_assert (context
22482 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
22483 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
22485 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
22486 if (origin)
22487 add_child_die (origin, die);
22488 else
22489 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
22494 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22496 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
22498 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
22500 tree decl = node->created_for;
22501 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
22503 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
22504 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
22508 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
22510 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
22511 emit full debugging info for them. */
22512 retry_incomplete_types ();
22514 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
22515 prune_unused_types ();
22517 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
22518 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
22519 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
22520 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
22522 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
22523 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
22525 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
22527 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
22528 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
22529 limbo die list. */
22530 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22532 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
22533 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
22534 references to the main compile unit). */
22535 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22536 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
22537 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
22539 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
22540 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
22541 referenced. Prune them. */
22542 prune_unused_types ();
22545 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
22546 that have children. */
22547 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
22548 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22549 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
22550 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22551 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
22553 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
22554 switch_to_section (text_section);
22555 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
22556 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
22558 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
22559 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
22562 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
22563 in .text. */
22564 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
22565 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22567 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
22568 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
22571 else
22573 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
22574 bool range_list_added = false;
22576 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
22577 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
22578 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
22579 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
22580 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
22581 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
22582 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
22584 if (text_section_used)
22585 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), text_section_label,
22586 text_end_label, &range_list_added);
22587 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && cold_text_section_used)
22588 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), cold_text_section_label,
22589 cold_end_label, &range_list_added);
22591 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
22593 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
22595 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
22597 if (!fde->in_std_section)
22598 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (),
22599 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
22600 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
22601 &range_list_added);
22602 if (!fde->cold_in_std_section)
22603 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (),
22604 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
22605 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
22606 &range_list_added);
22608 else if (!fde->in_std_section)
22609 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), fde->dw_fde_begin,
22610 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
22613 if (range_list_added)
22614 add_ranges (NULL);
22617 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22618 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list,
22619 debug_line_section_label);
22621 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22622 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
22624 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
22625 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
22626 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22627 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
22629 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
22630 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22632 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
22634 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
22635 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
22636 continue;
22638 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
22639 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
22640 attributes. */
22641 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22642 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
22643 debug_line_section_label);
22645 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
22646 *slot = ctnode;
22648 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
22650 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
22651 has been emitted. */
22652 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE);
22654 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
22655 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
22656 output_abbrev_section ();
22658 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
22659 if (have_location_lists)
22661 /* Output the location lists info. */
22662 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
22663 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
22664 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22665 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
22666 output_location_lists (die);
22669 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
22670 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
22672 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
22673 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
22676 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
22677 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
22678 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
22679 simply won't look for the section. */
22680 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
22682 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
22683 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
22686 /* Output direct and virtual call tables if necessary. */
22687 if (!VEC_empty (dcall_entry, dcall_table))
22689 switch_to_section (debug_dcall_section);
22690 output_dcall_table ();
22692 if (!VEC_empty (vcall_entry, vcall_table))
22694 switch_to_section (debug_vcall_section);
22695 output_vcall_table ();
22698 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
22699 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
22700 if (fde_table_in_use)
22702 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
22703 output_aranges ();
22706 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
22707 if (ranges_table_in_use)
22709 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
22710 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
22711 output_ranges ();
22714 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
22715 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
22716 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
22717 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
22718 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
22719 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
22720 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
22722 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
22723 output_line_info ();
22726 /* Have to end the macro section. */
22727 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22729 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
22730 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
22733 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
22734 table too. */
22735 if (debug_str_hash)
22736 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
22739 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"